Transaction Hash:
Block:
16999822 at Apr-07-2023 11:21:59 PM +UTC
Transaction Fee:
0.013060264773400027 ETH
$26.72
Gas Used:
530,921 Gas / 24.599261987 Gwei
Emitted Events:
| 262 |
SAS.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=6647 )
|
| 263 |
SAS.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=3184 )
|
| 264 |
BoredPunksYachtClub.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=7916 )
|
| 265 |
DegenWarriors.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=951 )
|
| 266 |
UghaBugha.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=1076 )
|
| 267 |
0xe0e72a832445d47451f8cb8a22f811168c86de99.0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef( 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef, 0x000000000000000000000000c1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, 0x00000000000000000000000099c820e11d5ee26a55755f24f7b6cb55ea782136, 0x000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000001b )
|
| 268 |
GoblinWaifu.Approval( owner=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, approved=0x00000000...000000000, tokenId=581 )
|
| 269 |
GoblinWaifu.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=581 )
|
| 270 |
MrBlock.Approval( owner=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, approved=0x00000000...000000000, tokenId=5655 )
|
| 271 |
MrBlock.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=5655 )
|
| 272 |
MrBlock.Approval( owner=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, approved=0x00000000...000000000, tokenId=4935 )
|
| 273 |
MrBlock.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=4935 )
|
| 274 |
MrBlock.Approval( owner=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, approved=0x00000000...000000000, tokenId=4934 )
|
| 275 |
MrBlock.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=4934 )
|
| 276 |
0xca77bdc583c13eb9714b108581b269d2e239eee0.0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef( 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef, 0x000000000000000000000000c1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, 0x00000000000000000000000099c820e11d5ee26a55755f24f7b6cb55ea782136, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000266 )
|
| 277 |
0xca77bdc583c13eb9714b108581b269d2e239eee0.0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef( 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef, 0x000000000000000000000000c1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, 0x00000000000000000000000099c820e11d5ee26a55755f24f7b6cb55ea782136, 0x000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000054c )
|
| 278 |
LFOX.Approval( owner=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, approved=0x00000000...000000000, tokenId=4976 )
|
| 279 |
LFOX.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=4976 )
|
| 280 |
LFOX.Approval( owner=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, approved=0x00000000...000000000, tokenId=464 )
|
| 281 |
LFOX.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0xc1fde2a334816beeb6c54688e3642278cecd00a5, to=0x99C820E1...5ea782136, tokenId=464 )
|
Account State Difference:
| Address | Before | After | State Difference | ||
|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 0x010B0940...59999003B | |||||
| 0x24435375...3e6B4892A | |||||
| 0x274AC60E...e1013E339 | |||||
| 0x7dE3E2F5...B08fcdcf3 | |||||
| 0xA2954517...6488d22C3 | |||||
| 0xa99a6129...ee1F4c39A | |||||
| 0xC1FdE2A3...8CeCD00a5 |
0.038326822888567684 Eth
Nonce: 415
|
0.025266558115167657 Eth
Nonce: 416
| 0.013060264773400027 | ||
| 0xca77BdC5...2e239EEe0 | |||||
| 0xd9c5a09f...106C7d695 | |||||
|
0xDAFEA492...692c98Bc5
Miner
| (Flashbots: Builder) | 1.218585401337559918 Eth | 1.218638493437559918 Eth | 0.0000530921 | |
| 0xE0E72A83...68c86DE99 |
Execution Trace
TransferHelper.bulkTransfer( items=, conduitKey=0000007B02230091A7ED01230072F7006A004D60A8D4E71D599B8104250F0000 ) => ( items=, conduitKey= )
OpenSea: Conduit.4ce34aa2( )
SAS.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=6647 )
-
OperatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed( registrant=0x7dE3E2F540Cf5c3065DE34Ac16A39DEB08fcdcf3, operator=0x1E0049783F008A0085193E00003D00cd54003c71 ) => ( True )
-
SAS.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=3184 )
-
OperatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed( registrant=0x7dE3E2F540Cf5c3065DE34Ac16A39DEB08fcdcf3, operator=0x1E0049783F008A0085193E00003D00cd54003c71 ) => ( True )
-
BoredPunksYachtClub.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=7916 )
-
OperatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed( registrant=0x010B094098f88138A9869F23f1764E359999003B, operator=0x1E0049783F008A0085193E00003D00cd54003c71 ) => ( True )
-
-
DegenWarriors.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=951 )
-
UghaBugha.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=1076 )
-
0xe0e72a832445d47451f8cb8a22f811168c86de99.23b872dd( )
GoblinWaifu.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=581 )
-
WyvernProxyRegistry.proxies( 0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5 ) => ( 0x9e39bE029611F1D132aA842B041b1880068dcF30 )
-
-
MrBlock.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=5655 )
-
MrBlock.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=4935 )
-
MrBlock.transferFrom( from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, tokenId=4934 )
-
0xca77bdc583c13eb9714b108581b269d2e239eee0.23b872dd( )
-
0xca77bdc583c13eb9714b108581b269d2e239eee0.23b872dd( )
-
LFOX.transferFrom( _from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, _to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, _tokenId=4976 )
-
LFOX.transferFrom( _from=0xC1FdE2A334816BEeB6c54688e3642278CeCD00a5, _to=0x99C820E11D5ee26a55755f24F7B6cB55ea782136, _tokenId=464 )
bulkTransfer[TransferHelper (ln:57)]
InvalidConduit[TransferHelper (ln:63)]_performTransfersWithConduit[TransferHelper (ln:66)]_checkRecipientIsNotZeroAddress[TransferHelper (ln:132)]RecipientCannotBeZeroAddress[TransferHelper (ln:292)]
InvalidERC20Identifier[TransferHelper (ln:148)]_checkERC721Receiver[TransferHelper (ln:157)]onERC721Received[TransferHelper (ln:252)]InvalidERC721Recipient[TransferHelper (ln:263)]ERC721ReceiverErrorRevertBytes[TransferHelper (ln:267)]ERC721ReceiverErrorRevertString[TransferHelper (ln:275)]
ConduitTransfer[TransferHelper (ln:166)]execute[TransferHelper (ln:180)]InvalidConduit[TransferHelper (ln:188)]ConduitErrorRevertString[TransferHelper (ln:193)]ConduitErrorRevertBytes[TransferHelper (ln:227)]
File 1 of 10: TransferHelper
File 2 of 10: SAS
File 3 of 10: BoredPunksYachtClub
File 4 of 10: DegenWarriors
File 5 of 10: UghaBugha
File 6 of 10: GoblinWaifu
File 7 of 10: MrBlock
File 8 of 10: LFOX
File 9 of 10: OperatorFilterRegistry
File 10 of 10: WyvernProxyRegistry
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
import { IERC721Receiver } from "../interfaces/IERC721Receiver.sol";
import "./TransferHelperStructs.sol";
import { ConduitInterface } from "../interfaces/ConduitInterface.sol";
import {
ConduitControllerInterface
} from "../interfaces/ConduitControllerInterface.sol";
import { Conduit } from "../conduit/Conduit.sol";
import { ConduitTransfer } from "../conduit/lib/ConduitStructs.sol";
import {
TransferHelperInterface
} from "../interfaces/TransferHelperInterface.sol";
import { TransferHelperErrors } from "../interfaces/TransferHelperErrors.sol";
/**
* @title TransferHelper
* @author stephankmin, stuckinaboot, ryanio
* @notice TransferHelper is a utility contract for transferring
* ERC20/ERC721/ERC1155 items in bulk to specific recipients.
*/
contract TransferHelper is TransferHelperInterface, TransferHelperErrors {
// Allow for interaction with the conduit controller.
ConduitControllerInterface internal immutable _CONDUIT_CONTROLLER;
// Set conduit creation code and runtime code hashes as immutable arguments.
bytes32 internal immutable _CONDUIT_CREATION_CODE_HASH;
bytes32 internal immutable _CONDUIT_RUNTIME_CODE_HASH;
/**
* @dev Set the supplied conduit controller and retrieve its
* conduit creation code hash.
*
*
* @param conduitController A contract that deploys conduits, or proxies
* that may optionally be used to transfer approved
* ERC20/721/1155 tokens.
*/
constructor(address conduitController) {
// Get the conduit creation code and runtime code hashes from the
// supplied conduit controller and set them as an immutable.
ConduitControllerInterface controller = ConduitControllerInterface(
conduitController
);
(_CONDUIT_CREATION_CODE_HASH, _CONDUIT_RUNTIME_CODE_HASH) = controller
.getConduitCodeHashes();
// Set the supplied conduit controller as an immutable.
_CONDUIT_CONTROLLER = controller;
}
/**
* @notice Transfer multiple ERC20/ERC721/ERC1155 items to
* specified recipients.
*
* @param items The items to transfer to an intended recipient.
* @param conduitKey An optional conduit key referring to a conduit through
* which the bulk transfer should occur.
*
* @return magicValue A value indicating that the transfers were successful.
*/
function bulkTransfer(
TransferHelperItemsWithRecipient[] calldata items,
bytes32 conduitKey
) external override returns (bytes4 magicValue) {
// Ensure that a conduit key has been supplied.
if (conduitKey == bytes32(0)) {
revert InvalidConduit(conduitKey, address(0));
}
// Use conduit derived from supplied conduit key to perform transfers.
_performTransfersWithConduit(items, conduitKey);
// Return a magic value indicating that the transfers were performed.
magicValue = this.bulkTransfer.selector;
}
/**
* @notice Perform multiple transfers to specified recipients via the
* conduit derived from the provided conduit key.
*
* @param transfers The items to transfer.
* @param conduitKey The conduit key referring to the conduit through
* which the bulk transfer should occur.
*/
function _performTransfersWithConduit(
TransferHelperItemsWithRecipient[] calldata transfers,
bytes32 conduitKey
) internal {
// Retrieve total number of transfers and place on stack.
uint256 numTransfers = transfers.length;
// Derive the conduit address from the deployer, conduit key
// and creation code hash.
address conduit = address(
uint160(
uint256(
keccak256(
abi.encodePacked(
bytes1(0xff),
address(_CONDUIT_CONTROLLER),
conduitKey,
_CONDUIT_CREATION_CODE_HASH
)
)
)
)
);
// Declare a variable to store the sum of all items across transfers.
uint256 sumOfItemsAcrossAllTransfers;
// Skip overflow checks: all for loops are indexed starting at zero.
unchecked {
// Iterate over each transfer.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numTransfers; ++i) {
// Retrieve the transfer in question.
TransferHelperItemsWithRecipient calldata transfer = transfers[
i
];
// Increment totalItems by the number of items in the transfer.
sumOfItemsAcrossAllTransfers += transfer.items.length;
}
}
// Declare a new array in memory with length totalItems to populate with
// each conduit transfer.
ConduitTransfer[] memory conduitTransfers = new ConduitTransfer[](
sumOfItemsAcrossAllTransfers
);
// Declare an index for storing ConduitTransfers in conduitTransfers.
uint256 itemIndex;
// Skip overflow checks: all for loops are indexed starting at zero.
unchecked {
// Iterate over each transfer.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numTransfers; ++i) {
// Retrieve the transfer in question.
TransferHelperItemsWithRecipient calldata transfer = transfers[
i
];
// Retrieve the items of the transfer in question.
TransferHelperItem[] calldata transferItems = transfer.items;
// Ensure recipient is not the zero address.
_checkRecipientIsNotZeroAddress(transfer.recipient);
// Create a boolean indicating whether validateERC721Receiver
// is true and recipient is a contract.
bool callERC721Receiver = transfer.validateERC721Receiver &&
transfer.recipient.code.length != 0;
// Retrieve the total number of items in the transfer and
// place on stack.
uint256 numItemsInTransfer = transferItems.length;
// Iterate over each item in the transfer to create a
// corresponding ConduitTransfer.
for (uint256 j = 0; j < numItemsInTransfer; ++j) {
// Retrieve the item from the transfer.
TransferHelperItem calldata item = transferItems[j];
if (item.itemType == ConduitItemType.ERC20) {
// Ensure that the identifier of an ERC20 token is 0.
if (item.identifier != 0) {
revert InvalidERC20Identifier();
}
}
// If the item is an ERC721 token and
// callERC721Receiver is true...
if (item.itemType == ConduitItemType.ERC721) {
if (callERC721Receiver) {
// Check if the recipient implements
// onERC721Received for the given tokenId.
_checkERC721Receiver(
conduit,
transfer.recipient,
item.identifier
);
}
}
// Create a ConduitTransfer corresponding to each
// TransferHelperItem.
conduitTransfers[itemIndex] = ConduitTransfer(
item.itemType,
item.token,
msg.sender,
transfer.recipient,
item.identifier,
item.amount
);
// Increment the index for storing ConduitTransfers.
++itemIndex;
}
}
}
// Attempt the external call to transfer tokens via the derived conduit.
try ConduitInterface(conduit).execute(conduitTransfers) returns (
bytes4 conduitMagicValue
) {
// Check if the value returned from the external call matches
// the conduit `execute` selector.
if (conduitMagicValue != ConduitInterface.execute.selector) {
// If the external call fails, revert with the conduit key
// and conduit address.
revert InvalidConduit(conduitKey, conduit);
}
} catch Error(string memory reason) {
// Catch reverts with a provided reason string and
// revert with the reason, conduit key and conduit address.
revert ConduitErrorRevertString(reason, conduitKey, conduit);
} catch (bytes memory data) {
// Conduits will throw a custom error when attempting to transfer
// native token item types or an ERC721 item amount other than 1.
// Bubble up these custom errors when encountered. Note that the
// conduit itself will bubble up revert reasons from transfers as
// well, meaning that these errors are not necessarily indicative of
// an issue with the item type or amount in cases where the same
// custom error signature is encountered during a conduit transfer.
// Set initial value of first four bytes of revert data to the mask.
bytes4 customErrorSelector = bytes4(0xffffffff);
// Utilize assembly to read first four bytes (if present) directly.
assembly {
// Combine original mask with first four bytes of revert data.
customErrorSelector := and(
mload(add(data, 0x20)), // Data begins after length offset.
customErrorSelector
)
}
// Pass through the custom error in question if the revert data is
// the correct length and matches an expected custom error selector.
if (
data.length == 4 &&
(customErrorSelector == InvalidItemType.selector ||
customErrorSelector == InvalidERC721TransferAmount.selector)
) {
// "Bubble up" the revert reason.
assembly {
revert(add(data, 0x20), 0x04)
}
}
// Catch all other reverts from the external call to the conduit and
// include the conduit's raw revert reason as a data argument to a
// new custom error.
revert ConduitErrorRevertBytes(data, conduitKey, conduit);
}
}
/**
* @notice An internal function to check if a recipient address implements
* onERC721Received for a given tokenId. Note that this check does
* not adhere to the safe transfer specification and is only meant
* to provide an additional layer of assurance that the recipient
* can receive the tokens — any hooks or post-transfer checks will
* fail and the caller will be the transfer helper rather than the
* ERC721 contract. Note that the conduit is set as the operator, as
* it will be the caller once the transfer is performed.
*
* @param conduit The conduit to provide as the operator when calling
* onERC721Received.
* @param recipient The ERC721 recipient on which to call onERC721Received.
* @param tokenId The ERC721 tokenId of the token being transferred.
*/
function _checkERC721Receiver(
address conduit,
address recipient,
uint256 tokenId
) internal {
// Check if recipient can receive ERC721 tokens.
try
IERC721Receiver(recipient).onERC721Received(
conduit,
msg.sender,
tokenId,
""
)
returns (bytes4 selector) {
// Check if onERC721Received selector is valid.
if (selector != IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector) {
// Revert if recipient cannot accept
// ERC721 tokens.
revert InvalidERC721Recipient(recipient);
}
} catch (bytes memory data) {
// "Bubble up" recipient's revert reason.
revert ERC721ReceiverErrorRevertBytes(
data,
recipient,
msg.sender,
tokenId
);
} catch Error(string memory reason) {
// "Bubble up" recipient's revert reason.
revert ERC721ReceiverErrorRevertString(
reason,
recipient,
msg.sender,
tokenId
);
}
}
/**
* @notice An internal function that reverts if the passed-in recipient
* is the zero address.
*
* @param recipient The recipient on which to perform the check.
*/
function _checkRecipientIsNotZeroAddress(address recipient) internal pure {
// Revert if the recipient is the zero address.
if (recipient == address(0x0)) {
revert RecipientCannotBeZeroAddress();
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
interface IERC721Receiver {
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
import { ConduitItemType } from "../conduit/lib/ConduitEnums.sol";
/**
* @dev A TransferHelperItem specifies the itemType (ERC20/ERC721/ERC1155),
* token address, token identifier, and amount of the token to be
* transferred via the TransferHelper. For ERC20 tokens, identifier
* must be 0. For ERC721 tokens, amount must be 1.
*/
struct TransferHelperItem {
ConduitItemType itemType;
address token;
uint256 identifier;
uint256 amount;
}
/**
* @dev A TransferHelperItemsWithRecipient specifies the tokens to transfer
* via the TransferHelper, their intended recipient, and a boolean flag
* indicating whether onERC721Received should be called on a recipient
* contract.
*/
struct TransferHelperItemsWithRecipient {
TransferHelperItem[] items;
address recipient;
bool validateERC721Receiver;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
import {
ConduitTransfer,
ConduitBatch1155Transfer
} from "../conduit/lib/ConduitStructs.sol";
/**
* @title ConduitInterface
* @author 0age
* @notice ConduitInterface contains all external function interfaces, events,
* and errors for conduit contracts.
*/
interface ConduitInterface {
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to execute transfers using a
* caller that does not have an open channel.
*/
error ChannelClosed(address channel);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to update a channel to the
* current status of that channel.
*/
error ChannelStatusAlreadySet(address channel, bool isOpen);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to execute a transfer for an
* item that does not have an ERC20/721/1155 item type.
*/
error InvalidItemType();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to update the status of a
* channel from a caller that is not the conduit controller.
*/
error InvalidController();
/**
* @dev Emit an event whenever a channel is opened or closed.
*
* @param channel The channel that has been updated.
* @param open A boolean indicating whether the conduit is open or not.
*/
event ChannelUpdated(address indexed channel, bool open);
/**
* @notice Execute a sequence of ERC20/721/1155 transfers. Only a caller
* with an open channel can call this function.
*
* @param transfers The ERC20/721/1155 transfers to perform.
*
* @return magicValue A magic value indicating that the transfers were
* performed successfully.
*/
function execute(ConduitTransfer[] calldata transfers)
external
returns (bytes4 magicValue);
/**
* @notice Execute a sequence of batch 1155 transfers. Only a caller with an
* open channel can call this function.
*
* @param batch1155Transfers The 1155 batch transfers to perform.
*
* @return magicValue A magic value indicating that the transfers were
* performed successfully.
*/
function executeBatch1155(
ConduitBatch1155Transfer[] calldata batch1155Transfers
) external returns (bytes4 magicValue);
/**
* @notice Execute a sequence of transfers, both single and batch 1155. Only
* a caller with an open channel can call this function.
*
* @param standardTransfers The ERC20/721/1155 transfers to perform.
* @param batch1155Transfers The 1155 batch transfers to perform.
*
* @return magicValue A magic value indicating that the transfers were
* performed successfully.
*/
function executeWithBatch1155(
ConduitTransfer[] calldata standardTransfers,
ConduitBatch1155Transfer[] calldata batch1155Transfers
) external returns (bytes4 magicValue);
/**
* @notice Open or close a given channel. Only callable by the controller.
*
* @param channel The channel to open or close.
* @param isOpen The status of the channel (either open or closed).
*/
function updateChannel(address channel, bool isOpen) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
/**
* @title ConduitControllerInterface
* @author 0age
* @notice ConduitControllerInterface contains all external function interfaces,
* structs, events, and errors for the conduit controller.
*/
interface ConduitControllerInterface {
/**
* @dev Track the conduit key, current owner, new potential owner, and open
* channels for each deployed conduit.
*/
struct ConduitProperties {
bytes32 key;
address owner;
address potentialOwner;
address[] channels;
mapping(address => uint256) channelIndexesPlusOne;
}
/**
* @dev Emit an event whenever a new conduit is created.
*
* @param conduit The newly created conduit.
* @param conduitKey The conduit key used to create the new conduit.
*/
event NewConduit(address conduit, bytes32 conduitKey);
/**
* @dev Emit an event whenever conduit ownership is transferred.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which ownership has been
* transferred.
* @param previousOwner The previous owner of the conduit.
* @param newOwner The new owner of the conduit.
*/
event OwnershipTransferred(
address indexed conduit,
address indexed previousOwner,
address indexed newOwner
);
/**
* @dev Emit an event whenever a conduit owner registers a new potential
* owner for that conduit.
*
* @param newPotentialOwner The new potential owner of the conduit.
*/
event PotentialOwnerUpdated(address indexed newPotentialOwner);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to create a new conduit using a
* conduit key where the first twenty bytes of the key do not match the
* address of the caller.
*/
error InvalidCreator();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to create a new conduit when no
* initial owner address is supplied.
*/
error InvalidInitialOwner();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to set a new potential owner
* that is already set.
*/
error NewPotentialOwnerAlreadySet(
address conduit,
address newPotentialOwner
);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to cancel ownership transfer
* when no new potential owner is currently set.
*/
error NoPotentialOwnerCurrentlySet(address conduit);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to interact with a conduit that
* does not yet exist.
*/
error NoConduit();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to create a conduit that
* already exists.
*/
error ConduitAlreadyExists(address conduit);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to update channels or transfer
* ownership of a conduit when the caller is not the owner of the
* conduit in question.
*/
error CallerIsNotOwner(address conduit);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to register a new potential
* owner and supplying the null address.
*/
error NewPotentialOwnerIsZeroAddress(address conduit);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to claim ownership of a conduit
* with a caller that is not the current potential owner for the
* conduit in question.
*/
error CallerIsNotNewPotentialOwner(address conduit);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to retrieve a channel using an
* index that is out of range.
*/
error ChannelOutOfRange(address conduit);
/**
* @notice Deploy a new conduit using a supplied conduit key and assigning
* an initial owner for the deployed conduit. Note that the first
* twenty bytes of the supplied conduit key must match the caller
* and that a new conduit cannot be created if one has already been
* deployed using the same conduit key.
*
* @param conduitKey The conduit key used to deploy the conduit. Note that
* the first twenty bytes of the conduit key must match
* the caller of this contract.
* @param initialOwner The initial owner to set for the new conduit.
*
* @return conduit The address of the newly deployed conduit.
*/
function createConduit(bytes32 conduitKey, address initialOwner)
external
returns (address conduit);
/**
* @notice Open or close a channel on a given conduit, thereby allowing the
* specified account to execute transfers against that conduit.
* Extreme care must be taken when updating channels, as malicious
* or vulnerable channels can transfer any ERC20, ERC721 and ERC1155
* tokens where the token holder has granted the conduit approval.
* Only the owner of the conduit in question may call this function.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to open or close the channel.
* @param channel The channel to open or close on the conduit.
* @param isOpen A boolean indicating whether to open or close the channel.
*/
function updateChannel(
address conduit,
address channel,
bool isOpen
) external;
/**
* @notice Initiate conduit ownership transfer by assigning a new potential
* owner for the given conduit. Once set, the new potential owner
* may call `acceptOwnership` to claim ownership of the conduit.
* Only the owner of the conduit in question may call this function.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to initiate ownership transfer.
* @param newPotentialOwner The new potential owner of the conduit.
*/
function transferOwnership(address conduit, address newPotentialOwner)
external;
/**
* @notice Clear the currently set potential owner, if any, from a conduit.
* Only the owner of the conduit in question may call this function.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to cancel ownership transfer.
*/
function cancelOwnershipTransfer(address conduit) external;
/**
* @notice Accept ownership of a supplied conduit. Only accounts that the
* current owner has set as the new potential owner may call this
* function.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to accept ownership.
*/
function acceptOwnership(address conduit) external;
/**
* @notice Retrieve the current owner of a deployed conduit.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to retrieve the associated owner.
*
* @return owner The owner of the supplied conduit.
*/
function ownerOf(address conduit) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @notice Retrieve the conduit key for a deployed conduit via reverse
* lookup.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to retrieve the associated conduit
* key.
*
* @return conduitKey The conduit key used to deploy the supplied conduit.
*/
function getKey(address conduit) external view returns (bytes32 conduitKey);
/**
* @notice Derive the conduit associated with a given conduit key and
* determine whether that conduit exists (i.e. whether it has been
* deployed).
*
* @param conduitKey The conduit key used to derive the conduit.
*
* @return conduit The derived address of the conduit.
* @return exists A boolean indicating whether the derived conduit has been
* deployed or not.
*/
function getConduit(bytes32 conduitKey)
external
view
returns (address conduit, bool exists);
/**
* @notice Retrieve the potential owner, if any, for a given conduit. The
* current owner may set a new potential owner via
* `transferOwnership` and that owner may then accept ownership of
* the conduit in question via `acceptOwnership`.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to retrieve the potential owner.
*
* @return potentialOwner The potential owner, if any, for the conduit.
*/
function getPotentialOwner(address conduit)
external
view
returns (address potentialOwner);
/**
* @notice Retrieve the status (either open or closed) of a given channel on
* a conduit.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to retrieve the channel status.
* @param channel The channel for which to retrieve the status.
*
* @return isOpen The status of the channel on the given conduit.
*/
function getChannelStatus(address conduit, address channel)
external
view
returns (bool isOpen);
/**
* @notice Retrieve the total number of open channels for a given conduit.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to retrieve the total channel count.
*
* @return totalChannels The total number of open channels for the conduit.
*/
function getTotalChannels(address conduit)
external
view
returns (uint256 totalChannels);
/**
* @notice Retrieve an open channel at a specific index for a given conduit.
* Note that the index of a channel can change as a result of other
* channels being closed on the conduit.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to retrieve the open channel.
* @param channelIndex The index of the channel in question.
*
* @return channel The open channel, if any, at the specified channel index.
*/
function getChannel(address conduit, uint256 channelIndex)
external
view
returns (address channel);
/**
* @notice Retrieve all open channels for a given conduit. Note that calling
* this function for a conduit with many channels will revert with
* an out-of-gas error.
*
* @param conduit The conduit for which to retrieve open channels.
*
* @return channels An array of open channels on the given conduit.
*/
function getChannels(address conduit)
external
view
returns (address[] memory channels);
/**
* @dev Retrieve the conduit creation code and runtime code hashes.
*/
function getConduitCodeHashes()
external
view
returns (bytes32 creationCodeHash, bytes32 runtimeCodeHash);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
import { ConduitInterface } from "../interfaces/ConduitInterface.sol";
import { ConduitItemType } from "./lib/ConduitEnums.sol";
import { TokenTransferrer } from "../lib/TokenTransferrer.sol";
import {
ConduitTransfer,
ConduitBatch1155Transfer
} from "./lib/ConduitStructs.sol";
import "./lib/ConduitConstants.sol";
/**
* @title Conduit
* @author 0age
* @notice This contract serves as an originator for "proxied" transfers. Each
* conduit is deployed and controlled by a "conduit controller" that can
* add and remove "channels" or contracts that can instruct the conduit
* to transfer approved ERC20/721/1155 tokens. *IMPORTANT NOTE: each
* conduit has an owner that can arbitrarily add or remove channels, and
* a malicious or negligent owner can add a channel that allows for any
* approved ERC20/721/1155 tokens to be taken immediately — be extremely
* cautious with what conduits you give token approvals to!*
*/
contract Conduit is ConduitInterface, TokenTransferrer {
// Set deployer as an immutable controller that can update channel statuses.
address private immutable _controller;
// Track the status of each channel.
mapping(address => bool) private _channels;
/**
* @notice Ensure that the caller is currently registered as an open channel
* on the conduit.
*/
modifier onlyOpenChannel() {
// Utilize assembly to access channel storage mapping directly.
assembly {
// Write the caller to scratch space.
mstore(ChannelKey_channel_ptr, caller())
// Write the storage slot for _channels to scratch space.
mstore(ChannelKey_slot_ptr, _channels.slot)
// Derive the position in storage of _channels[msg.sender]
// and check if the stored value is zero.
if iszero(
sload(keccak256(ChannelKey_channel_ptr, ChannelKey_length))
) {
// The caller is not an open channel; revert with
// ChannelClosed(caller). First, set error signature in memory.
mstore(ChannelClosed_error_ptr, ChannelClosed_error_signature)
// Next, set the caller as the argument.
mstore(ChannelClosed_channel_ptr, caller())
// Finally, revert, returning full custom error with argument.
revert(ChannelClosed_error_ptr, ChannelClosed_error_length)
}
}
// Continue with function execution.
_;
}
/**
* @notice In the constructor, set the deployer as the controller.
*/
constructor() {
// Set the deployer as the controller.
_controller = msg.sender;
}
/**
* @notice Execute a sequence of ERC20/721/1155 transfers. Only a caller
* with an open channel can call this function. Note that channels
* are expected to implement reentrancy protection if desired, and
* that cross-channel reentrancy may be possible if the conduit has
* multiple open channels at once. Also note that channels are
* expected to implement checks against transferring any zero-amount
* items if that constraint is desired.
*
* @param transfers The ERC20/721/1155 transfers to perform.
*
* @return magicValue A magic value indicating that the transfers were
* performed successfully.
*/
function execute(ConduitTransfer[] calldata transfers)
external
override
onlyOpenChannel
returns (bytes4 magicValue)
{
// Retrieve the total number of transfers and place on the stack.
uint256 totalStandardTransfers = transfers.length;
// Iterate over each transfer.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalStandardTransfers; ) {
// Retrieve the transfer in question and perform the transfer.
_transfer(transfers[i]);
// Skip overflow check as for loop is indexed starting at zero.
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
// Return a magic value indicating that the transfers were performed.
magicValue = this.execute.selector;
}
/**
* @notice Execute a sequence of batch 1155 item transfers. Only a caller
* with an open channel can call this function. Note that channels
* are expected to implement reentrancy protection if desired, and
* that cross-channel reentrancy may be possible if the conduit has
* multiple open channels at once. Also note that channels are
* expected to implement checks against transferring any zero-amount
* items if that constraint is desired.
*
* @param batchTransfers The 1155 batch item transfers to perform.
*
* @return magicValue A magic value indicating that the item transfers were
* performed successfully.
*/
function executeBatch1155(
ConduitBatch1155Transfer[] calldata batchTransfers
) external override onlyOpenChannel returns (bytes4 magicValue) {
// Perform 1155 batch transfers. Note that memory should be considered
// entirely corrupted from this point forward.
_performERC1155BatchTransfers(batchTransfers);
// Return a magic value indicating that the transfers were performed.
magicValue = this.executeBatch1155.selector;
}
/**
* @notice Execute a sequence of transfers, both single ERC20/721/1155 item
* transfers as well as batch 1155 item transfers. Only a caller
* with an open channel can call this function. Note that channels
* are expected to implement reentrancy protection if desired, and
* that cross-channel reentrancy may be possible if the conduit has
* multiple open channels at once. Also note that channels are
* expected to implement checks against transferring any zero-amount
* items if that constraint is desired.
*
* @param standardTransfers The ERC20/721/1155 item transfers to perform.
* @param batchTransfers The 1155 batch item transfers to perform.
*
* @return magicValue A magic value indicating that the item transfers were
* performed successfully.
*/
function executeWithBatch1155(
ConduitTransfer[] calldata standardTransfers,
ConduitBatch1155Transfer[] calldata batchTransfers
) external override onlyOpenChannel returns (bytes4 magicValue) {
// Retrieve the total number of transfers and place on the stack.
uint256 totalStandardTransfers = standardTransfers.length;
// Iterate over each standard transfer.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalStandardTransfers; ) {
// Retrieve the transfer in question and perform the transfer.
_transfer(standardTransfers[i]);
// Skip overflow check as for loop is indexed starting at zero.
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
// Perform 1155 batch transfers. Note that memory should be considered
// entirely corrupted from this point forward aside from the free memory
// pointer having the default value.
_performERC1155BatchTransfers(batchTransfers);
// Return a magic value indicating that the transfers were performed.
magicValue = this.executeWithBatch1155.selector;
}
/**
* @notice Open or close a given channel. Only callable by the controller.
*
* @param channel The channel to open or close.
* @param isOpen The status of the channel (either open or closed).
*/
function updateChannel(address channel, bool isOpen) external override {
// Ensure that the caller is the controller of this contract.
if (msg.sender != _controller) {
revert InvalidController();
}
// Ensure that the channel does not already have the indicated status.
if (_channels[channel] == isOpen) {
revert ChannelStatusAlreadySet(channel, isOpen);
}
// Update the status of the channel.
_channels[channel] = isOpen;
// Emit a corresponding event.
emit ChannelUpdated(channel, isOpen);
}
/**
* @dev Internal function to transfer a given ERC20/721/1155 item. Note that
* channels are expected to implement checks against transferring any
* zero-amount items if that constraint is desired.
*
* @param item The ERC20/721/1155 item to transfer.
*/
function _transfer(ConduitTransfer calldata item) internal {
// Determine the transfer method based on the respective item type.
if (item.itemType == ConduitItemType.ERC20) {
// Transfer ERC20 token. Note that item.identifier is ignored and
// therefore ERC20 transfer items are potentially malleable — this
// check should be performed by the calling channel if a constraint
// on item malleability is desired.
_performERC20Transfer(item.token, item.from, item.to, item.amount);
} else if (item.itemType == ConduitItemType.ERC721) {
// Ensure that exactly one 721 item is being transferred.
if (item.amount != 1) {
revert InvalidERC721TransferAmount();
}
// Transfer ERC721 token.
_performERC721Transfer(
item.token,
item.from,
item.to,
item.identifier
);
} else if (item.itemType == ConduitItemType.ERC1155) {
// Transfer ERC1155 token.
_performERC1155Transfer(
item.token,
item.from,
item.to,
item.identifier,
item.amount
);
} else {
// Throw with an error.
revert InvalidItemType();
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
import { ConduitItemType } from "./ConduitEnums.sol";
struct ConduitTransfer {
ConduitItemType itemType;
address token;
address from;
address to;
uint256 identifier;
uint256 amount;
}
struct ConduitBatch1155Transfer {
address token;
address from;
address to;
uint256[] ids;
uint256[] amounts;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
import {
TransferHelperItem,
TransferHelperItemsWithRecipient
} from "../helpers/TransferHelperStructs.sol";
interface TransferHelperInterface {
/**
* @notice Transfer multiple items to a single recipient.
*
* @param items The items to transfer.
* @param conduitKey The key of the conduit performing the bulk transfer.
*/
function bulkTransfer(
TransferHelperItemsWithRecipient[] calldata items,
bytes32 conduitKey
) external returns (bytes4);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
/**
* @title TransferHelperErrors
*/
interface TransferHelperErrors {
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to execute transfers with a
* NATIVE itemType.
*/
error InvalidItemType();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when an ERC721 transfer with amount other than
* one is attempted.
*/
error InvalidERC721TransferAmount();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to execute an ERC721 transfer
* to an invalid recipient.
*/
error InvalidERC721Recipient(address recipient);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when a call to a ERC721 receiver reverts with
* bytes data.
*/
error ERC721ReceiverErrorRevertBytes(
bytes reason,
address receiver,
address sender,
uint256 identifier
);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when a call to a ERC721 receiver reverts with
* string reason.
*/
error ERC721ReceiverErrorRevertString(
string reason,
address receiver,
address sender,
uint256 identifier
);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when an ERC20 token has an invalid identifier.
*/
error InvalidERC20Identifier();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error if the recipient is the zero address.
*/
error RecipientCannotBeZeroAddress();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to fill an order referencing an
* invalid conduit (i.e. one that has not been deployed).
*/
error InvalidConduit(bytes32 conduitKey, address conduit);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when a call to a conduit reverts with a
* reason string.
*/
error ConduitErrorRevertString(
string reason,
bytes32 conduitKey,
address conduit
);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when a call to a conduit reverts with bytes
* data.
*/
error ConduitErrorRevertBytes(
bytes reason,
bytes32 conduitKey,
address conduit
);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
enum ConduitItemType {
NATIVE, // unused
ERC20,
ERC721,
ERC1155
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
import "./TokenTransferrerConstants.sol";
import {
TokenTransferrerErrors
} from "../interfaces/TokenTransferrerErrors.sol";
import { ConduitBatch1155Transfer } from "../conduit/lib/ConduitStructs.sol";
/**
* @title TokenTransferrer
* @author 0age
* @custom:coauthor d1ll0n
* @custom:coauthor transmissions11
* @notice TokenTransferrer is a library for performing optimized ERC20, ERC721,
* ERC1155, and batch ERC1155 transfers, used by both Seaport as well as
* by conduits deployed by the ConduitController. Use great caution when
* considering these functions for use in other codebases, as there are
* significant side effects and edge cases that need to be thoroughly
* understood and carefully addressed.
*/
contract TokenTransferrer is TokenTransferrerErrors {
/**
* @dev Internal function to transfer ERC20 tokens from a given originator
* to a given recipient. Sufficient approvals must be set on the
* contract performing the transfer.
*
* @param token The ERC20 token to transfer.
* @param from The originator of the transfer.
* @param to The recipient of the transfer.
* @param amount The amount to transfer.
*/
function _performERC20Transfer(
address token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 amount
) internal {
// Utilize assembly to perform an optimized ERC20 token transfer.
assembly {
// The free memory pointer memory slot will be used when populating
// call data for the transfer; read the value and restore it later.
let memPointer := mload(FreeMemoryPointerSlot)
// Write call data into memory, starting with function selector.
mstore(ERC20_transferFrom_sig_ptr, ERC20_transferFrom_signature)
mstore(ERC20_transferFrom_from_ptr, from)
mstore(ERC20_transferFrom_to_ptr, to)
mstore(ERC20_transferFrom_amount_ptr, amount)
// Make call & copy up to 32 bytes of return data to scratch space.
// Scratch space does not need to be cleared ahead of time, as the
// subsequent check will ensure that either at least a full word of
// return data is received (in which case it will be overwritten) or
// that no data is received (in which case scratch space will be
// ignored) on a successful call to the given token.
let callStatus := call(
gas(),
token,
0,
ERC20_transferFrom_sig_ptr,
ERC20_transferFrom_length,
0,
OneWord
)
// Determine whether transfer was successful using status & result.
let success := and(
// Set success to whether the call reverted, if not check it
// either returned exactly 1 (can't just be non-zero data), or
// had no return data.
or(
and(eq(mload(0), 1), gt(returndatasize(), 31)),
iszero(returndatasize())
),
callStatus
)
// Handle cases where either the transfer failed or no data was
// returned. Group these, as most transfers will succeed with data.
// Equivalent to `or(iszero(success), iszero(returndatasize()))`
// but after it's inverted for JUMPI this expression is cheaper.
if iszero(and(success, iszero(iszero(returndatasize())))) {
// If the token has no code or the transfer failed: Equivalent
// to `or(iszero(success), iszero(extcodesize(token)))` but
// after it's inverted for JUMPI this expression is cheaper.
if iszero(and(iszero(iszero(extcodesize(token))), success)) {
// If the transfer failed:
if iszero(success) {
// If it was due to a revert:
if iszero(callStatus) {
// If it returned a message, bubble it up as long as
// sufficient gas remains to do so:
if returndatasize() {
// Ensure that sufficient gas is available to
// copy returndata while expanding memory where
// necessary. Start by computing the word size
// of returndata and allocated memory. Round up
// to the nearest full word.
let returnDataWords := div(
add(returndatasize(), AlmostOneWord),
OneWord
)
// Note: use the free memory pointer in place of
// msize() to work around a Yul warning that
// prevents accessing msize directly when the IR
// pipeline is activated.
let msizeWords := div(memPointer, OneWord)
// Next, compute the cost of the returndatacopy.
let cost := mul(CostPerWord, returnDataWords)
// Then, compute cost of new memory allocation.
if gt(returnDataWords, msizeWords) {
cost := add(
cost,
add(
mul(
sub(
returnDataWords,
msizeWords
),
CostPerWord
),
div(
sub(
mul(
returnDataWords,
returnDataWords
),
mul(msizeWords, msizeWords)
),
MemoryExpansionCoefficient
)
)
)
}
// Finally, add a small constant and compare to
// gas remaining; bubble up the revert data if
// enough gas is still available.
if lt(add(cost, ExtraGasBuffer), gas()) {
// Copy returndata to memory; overwrite
// existing memory.
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
// Revert, specifying memory region with
// copied returndata.
revert(0, returndatasize())
}
}
// Otherwise revert with a generic error message.
mstore(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_sig_ptr,
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_signature
)
mstore(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_token_ptr,
token
)
mstore(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_from_ptr,
from
)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_to_ptr, to)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_id_ptr, 0)
mstore(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_amount_ptr,
amount
)
revert(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_sig_ptr,
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_length
)
}
// Otherwise revert with a message about the token
// returning false or non-compliant return values.
mstore(
BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_sig_ptr,
BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_signature
)
mstore(
BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_token_ptr,
token
)
mstore(
BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_from_ptr,
from
)
mstore(
BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_to_ptr,
to
)
mstore(
BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_amount_ptr,
amount
)
revert(
BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_sig_ptr,
BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_length
)
}
// Otherwise, revert with error about token not having code:
mstore(NoContract_error_sig_ptr, NoContract_error_signature)
mstore(NoContract_error_token_ptr, token)
revert(NoContract_error_sig_ptr, NoContract_error_length)
}
// Otherwise, the token just returned no data despite the call
// having succeeded; no need to optimize for this as it's not
// technically ERC20 compliant.
}
// Restore the original free memory pointer.
mstore(FreeMemoryPointerSlot, memPointer)
// Restore the zero slot to zero.
mstore(ZeroSlot, 0)
}
}
/**
* @dev Internal function to transfer an ERC721 token from a given
* originator to a given recipient. Sufficient approvals must be set on
* the contract performing the transfer. Note that this function does
* not check whether the receiver can accept the ERC721 token (i.e. it
* does not use `safeTransferFrom`).
*
* @param token The ERC721 token to transfer.
* @param from The originator of the transfer.
* @param to The recipient of the transfer.
* @param identifier The tokenId to transfer.
*/
function _performERC721Transfer(
address token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 identifier
) internal {
// Utilize assembly to perform an optimized ERC721 token transfer.
assembly {
// If the token has no code, revert.
if iszero(extcodesize(token)) {
mstore(NoContract_error_sig_ptr, NoContract_error_signature)
mstore(NoContract_error_token_ptr, token)
revert(NoContract_error_sig_ptr, NoContract_error_length)
}
// The free memory pointer memory slot will be used when populating
// call data for the transfer; read the value and restore it later.
let memPointer := mload(FreeMemoryPointerSlot)
// Write call data to memory starting with function selector.
mstore(ERC721_transferFrom_sig_ptr, ERC721_transferFrom_signature)
mstore(ERC721_transferFrom_from_ptr, from)
mstore(ERC721_transferFrom_to_ptr, to)
mstore(ERC721_transferFrom_id_ptr, identifier)
// Perform the call, ignoring return data.
let success := call(
gas(),
token,
0,
ERC721_transferFrom_sig_ptr,
ERC721_transferFrom_length,
0,
0
)
// If the transfer reverted:
if iszero(success) {
// If it returned a message, bubble it up as long as sufficient
// gas remains to do so:
if returndatasize() {
// Ensure that sufficient gas is available to copy
// returndata while expanding memory where necessary. Start
// by computing word size of returndata & allocated memory.
// Round up to the nearest full word.
let returnDataWords := div(
add(returndatasize(), AlmostOneWord),
OneWord
)
// Note: use the free memory pointer in place of msize() to
// work around a Yul warning that prevents accessing msize
// directly when the IR pipeline is activated.
let msizeWords := div(memPointer, OneWord)
// Next, compute the cost of the returndatacopy.
let cost := mul(CostPerWord, returnDataWords)
// Then, compute cost of new memory allocation.
if gt(returnDataWords, msizeWords) {
cost := add(
cost,
add(
mul(
sub(returnDataWords, msizeWords),
CostPerWord
),
div(
sub(
mul(returnDataWords, returnDataWords),
mul(msizeWords, msizeWords)
),
MemoryExpansionCoefficient
)
)
)
}
// Finally, add a small constant and compare to gas
// remaining; bubble up the revert data if enough gas is
// still available.
if lt(add(cost, ExtraGasBuffer), gas()) {
// Copy returndata to memory; overwrite existing memory.
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
// Revert, giving memory region with copied returndata.
revert(0, returndatasize())
}
}
// Otherwise revert with a generic error message.
mstore(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_sig_ptr,
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_signature
)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_token_ptr, token)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_from_ptr, from)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_to_ptr, to)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_id_ptr, identifier)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_amount_ptr, 1)
revert(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_sig_ptr,
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_length
)
}
// Restore the original free memory pointer.
mstore(FreeMemoryPointerSlot, memPointer)
// Restore the zero slot to zero.
mstore(ZeroSlot, 0)
}
}
/**
* @dev Internal function to transfer ERC1155 tokens from a given
* originator to a given recipient. Sufficient approvals must be set on
* the contract performing the transfer and contract recipients must
* implement the ERC1155TokenReceiver interface to indicate that they
* are willing to accept the transfer.
*
* @param token The ERC1155 token to transfer.
* @param from The originator of the transfer.
* @param to The recipient of the transfer.
* @param identifier The id to transfer.
* @param amount The amount to transfer.
*/
function _performERC1155Transfer(
address token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 identifier,
uint256 amount
) internal {
// Utilize assembly to perform an optimized ERC1155 token transfer.
assembly {
// If the token has no code, revert.
if iszero(extcodesize(token)) {
mstore(NoContract_error_sig_ptr, NoContract_error_signature)
mstore(NoContract_error_token_ptr, token)
revert(NoContract_error_sig_ptr, NoContract_error_length)
}
// The following memory slots will be used when populating call data
// for the transfer; read the values and restore them later.
let memPointer := mload(FreeMemoryPointerSlot)
let slot0x80 := mload(Slot0x80)
let slot0xA0 := mload(Slot0xA0)
let slot0xC0 := mload(Slot0xC0)
// Write call data into memory, beginning with function selector.
mstore(
ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_sig_ptr,
ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_signature
)
mstore(ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_from_ptr, from)
mstore(ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_to_ptr, to)
mstore(ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_id_ptr, identifier)
mstore(ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_amount_ptr, amount)
mstore(
ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_data_offset_ptr,
ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_data_length_offset
)
mstore(ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_data_length_ptr, 0)
// Perform the call, ignoring return data.
let success := call(
gas(),
token,
0,
ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_sig_ptr,
ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_length,
0,
0
)
// If the transfer reverted:
if iszero(success) {
// If it returned a message, bubble it up as long as sufficient
// gas remains to do so:
if returndatasize() {
// Ensure that sufficient gas is available to copy
// returndata while expanding memory where necessary. Start
// by computing word size of returndata & allocated memory.
// Round up to the nearest full word.
let returnDataWords := div(
add(returndatasize(), AlmostOneWord),
OneWord
)
// Note: use the free memory pointer in place of msize() to
// work around a Yul warning that prevents accessing msize
// directly when the IR pipeline is activated.
let msizeWords := div(memPointer, OneWord)
// Next, compute the cost of the returndatacopy.
let cost := mul(CostPerWord, returnDataWords)
// Then, compute cost of new memory allocation.
if gt(returnDataWords, msizeWords) {
cost := add(
cost,
add(
mul(
sub(returnDataWords, msizeWords),
CostPerWord
),
div(
sub(
mul(returnDataWords, returnDataWords),
mul(msizeWords, msizeWords)
),
MemoryExpansionCoefficient
)
)
)
}
// Finally, add a small constant and compare to gas
// remaining; bubble up the revert data if enough gas is
// still available.
if lt(add(cost, ExtraGasBuffer), gas()) {
// Copy returndata to memory; overwrite existing memory.
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
// Revert, giving memory region with copied returndata.
revert(0, returndatasize())
}
}
// Otherwise revert with a generic error message.
mstore(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_sig_ptr,
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_signature
)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_token_ptr, token)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_from_ptr, from)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_to_ptr, to)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_id_ptr, identifier)
mstore(TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_amount_ptr, amount)
revert(
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_sig_ptr,
TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_length
)
}
mstore(Slot0x80, slot0x80) // Restore slot 0x80.
mstore(Slot0xA0, slot0xA0) // Restore slot 0xA0.
mstore(Slot0xC0, slot0xC0) // Restore slot 0xC0.
// Restore the original free memory pointer.
mstore(FreeMemoryPointerSlot, memPointer)
// Restore the zero slot to zero.
mstore(ZeroSlot, 0)
}
}
/**
* @dev Internal function to transfer ERC1155 tokens from a given
* originator to a given recipient. Sufficient approvals must be set on
* the contract performing the transfer and contract recipients must
* implement the ERC1155TokenReceiver interface to indicate that they
* are willing to accept the transfer. NOTE: this function is not
* memory-safe; it will overwrite existing memory, restore the free
* memory pointer to the default value, and overwrite the zero slot.
* This function should only be called once memory is no longer
* required and when uninitialized arrays are not utilized, and memory
* should be considered fully corrupted (aside from the existence of a
* default-value free memory pointer) after calling this function.
*
* @param batchTransfers The group of 1155 batch transfers to perform.
*/
function _performERC1155BatchTransfers(
ConduitBatch1155Transfer[] calldata batchTransfers
) internal {
// Utilize assembly to perform optimized batch 1155 transfers.
assembly {
let len := batchTransfers.length
// Pointer to first head in the array, which is offset to the struct
// at each index. This gets incremented after each loop to avoid
// multiplying by 32 to get the offset for each element.
let nextElementHeadPtr := batchTransfers.offset
// Pointer to beginning of the head of the array. This is the
// reference position each offset references. It's held static to
// let each loop calculate the data position for an element.
let arrayHeadPtr := nextElementHeadPtr
// Write the function selector, which will be reused for each call:
// safeBatchTransferFrom(address,address,uint256[],uint256[],bytes)
mstore(
ConduitBatch1155Transfer_from_offset,
ERC1155_safeBatchTransferFrom_signature
)
// Iterate over each batch transfer.
for {
let i := 0
} lt(i, len) {
i := add(i, 1)
} {
// Read the offset to the beginning of the element and add
// it to pointer to the beginning of the array head to get
// the absolute position of the element in calldata.
let elementPtr := add(
arrayHeadPtr,
calldataload(nextElementHeadPtr)
)
// Retrieve the token from calldata.
let token := calldataload(elementPtr)
// If the token has no code, revert.
if iszero(extcodesize(token)) {
mstore(NoContract_error_sig_ptr, NoContract_error_signature)
mstore(NoContract_error_token_ptr, token)
revert(NoContract_error_sig_ptr, NoContract_error_length)
}
// Get the total number of supplied ids.
let idsLength := calldataload(
add(elementPtr, ConduitBatch1155Transfer_ids_length_offset)
)
// Determine the expected offset for the amounts array.
let expectedAmountsOffset := add(
ConduitBatch1155Transfer_amounts_length_baseOffset,
mul(idsLength, OneWord)
)
// Validate struct encoding.
let invalidEncoding := iszero(
and(
// ids.length == amounts.length
eq(
idsLength,
calldataload(add(elementPtr, expectedAmountsOffset))
),
and(
// ids_offset == 0xa0
eq(
calldataload(
add(
elementPtr,
ConduitBatch1155Transfer_ids_head_offset
)
),
ConduitBatch1155Transfer_ids_length_offset
),
// amounts_offset == 0xc0 + ids.length*32
eq(
calldataload(
add(
elementPtr,
ConduitBatchTransfer_amounts_head_offset
)
),
expectedAmountsOffset
)
)
)
)
// Revert with an error if the encoding is not valid.
if invalidEncoding {
mstore(
Invalid1155BatchTransferEncoding_ptr,
Invalid1155BatchTransferEncoding_selector
)
revert(
Invalid1155BatchTransferEncoding_ptr,
Invalid1155BatchTransferEncoding_length
)
}
// Update the offset position for the next loop
nextElementHeadPtr := add(nextElementHeadPtr, OneWord)
// Copy the first section of calldata (before dynamic values).
calldatacopy(
BatchTransfer1155Params_ptr,
add(elementPtr, ConduitBatch1155Transfer_from_offset),
ConduitBatch1155Transfer_usable_head_size
)
// Determine size of calldata required for ids and amounts. Note
// that the size includes both lengths as well as the data.
let idsAndAmountsSize := add(TwoWords, mul(idsLength, TwoWords))
// Update the offset for the data array in memory.
mstore(
BatchTransfer1155Params_data_head_ptr,
add(
BatchTransfer1155Params_ids_length_offset,
idsAndAmountsSize
)
)
// Set the length of the data array in memory to zero.
mstore(
add(
BatchTransfer1155Params_data_length_basePtr,
idsAndAmountsSize
),
0
)
// Determine the total calldata size for the call to transfer.
let transferDataSize := add(
BatchTransfer1155Params_calldata_baseSize,
idsAndAmountsSize
)
// Copy second section of calldata (including dynamic values).
calldatacopy(
BatchTransfer1155Params_ids_length_ptr,
add(elementPtr, ConduitBatch1155Transfer_ids_length_offset),
idsAndAmountsSize
)
// Perform the call to transfer 1155 tokens.
let success := call(
gas(),
token,
0,
ConduitBatch1155Transfer_from_offset, // Data portion start.
transferDataSize, // Location of the length of callData.
0,
0
)
// If the transfer reverted:
if iszero(success) {
// If it returned a message, bubble it up as long as
// sufficient gas remains to do so:
if returndatasize() {
// Ensure that sufficient gas is available to copy
// returndata while expanding memory where necessary.
// Start by computing word size of returndata and
// allocated memory. Round up to the nearest full word.
let returnDataWords := div(
add(returndatasize(), AlmostOneWord),
OneWord
)
// Note: use transferDataSize in place of msize() to
// work around a Yul warning that prevents accessing
// msize directly when the IR pipeline is activated.
// The free memory pointer is not used here because
// this function does almost all memory management
// manually and does not update it, and transferDataSize
// should be the largest memory value used (unless a
// previous batch was larger).
let msizeWords := div(transferDataSize, OneWord)
// Next, compute the cost of the returndatacopy.
let cost := mul(CostPerWord, returnDataWords)
// Then, compute cost of new memory allocation.
if gt(returnDataWords, msizeWords) {
cost := add(
cost,
add(
mul(
sub(returnDataWords, msizeWords),
CostPerWord
),
div(
sub(
mul(
returnDataWords,
returnDataWords
),
mul(msizeWords, msizeWords)
),
MemoryExpansionCoefficient
)
)
)
}
// Finally, add a small constant and compare to gas
// remaining; bubble up the revert data if enough gas is
// still available.
if lt(add(cost, ExtraGasBuffer), gas()) {
// Copy returndata to memory; overwrite existing.
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
// Revert with memory region containing returndata.
revert(0, returndatasize())
}
}
// Set the error signature.
mstore(
0,
ERC1155BatchTransferGenericFailure_error_signature
)
// Write the token.
mstore(ERC1155BatchTransferGenericFailure_token_ptr, token)
// Increase the offset to ids by 32.
mstore(
BatchTransfer1155Params_ids_head_ptr,
ERC1155BatchTransferGenericFailure_ids_offset
)
// Increase the offset to amounts by 32.
mstore(
BatchTransfer1155Params_amounts_head_ptr,
add(
OneWord,
mload(BatchTransfer1155Params_amounts_head_ptr)
)
)
// Return modified region. The total size stays the same as
// `token` uses the same number of bytes as `data.length`.
revert(0, transferDataSize)
}
}
// Reset the free memory pointer to the default value; memory must
// be assumed to be dirtied and not reused from this point forward.
// Also note that the zero slot is not reset to zero, meaning empty
// arrays cannot be safely created or utilized until it is restored.
mstore(FreeMemoryPointerSlot, DefaultFreeMemoryPointer)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
// error ChannelClosed(address channel)
uint256 constant ChannelClosed_error_signature = (
0x93daadf200000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
uint256 constant ChannelClosed_error_ptr = 0x00;
uint256 constant ChannelClosed_channel_ptr = 0x4;
uint256 constant ChannelClosed_error_length = 0x24;
// For the mapping:
// mapping(address => bool) channels
// The position in storage for a particular account is:
// keccak256(abi.encode(account, channels.slot))
uint256 constant ChannelKey_channel_ptr = 0x00;
uint256 constant ChannelKey_slot_ptr = 0x20;
uint256 constant ChannelKey_length = 0x40;
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
/*
* -------------------------- Disambiguation & Other Notes ---------------------
* - The term "head" is used as it is in the documentation for ABI encoding,
* but only in reference to dynamic types, i.e. it always refers to the
* offset or pointer to the body of a dynamic type. In calldata, the head
* is always an offset (relative to the parent object), while in memory,
* the head is always the pointer to the body. More information found here:
* https://docs.soliditylang.org/en/v0.8.14/abi-spec.html#argument-encoding
* - Note that the length of an array is separate from and precedes the
* head of the array.
*
* - The term "body" is used in place of the term "head" used in the ABI
* documentation. It refers to the start of the data for a dynamic type,
* e.g. the first word of a struct or the first word of the first element
* in an array.
*
* - The term "pointer" is used to describe the absolute position of a value
* and never an offset relative to another value.
* - The suffix "_ptr" refers to a memory pointer.
* - The suffix "_cdPtr" refers to a calldata pointer.
*
* - The term "offset" is used to describe the position of a value relative
* to some parent value. For example, OrderParameters_conduit_offset is the
* offset to the "conduit" value in the OrderParameters struct relative to
* the start of the body.
* - Note: Offsets are used to derive pointers.
*
* - Some structs have pointers defined for all of their fields in this file.
* Lines which are commented out are fields that are not used in the
* codebase but have been left in for readability.
*/
uint256 constant AlmostOneWord = 0x1f;
uint256 constant OneWord = 0x20;
uint256 constant TwoWords = 0x40;
uint256 constant ThreeWords = 0x60;
uint256 constant FreeMemoryPointerSlot = 0x40;
uint256 constant ZeroSlot = 0x60;
uint256 constant DefaultFreeMemoryPointer = 0x80;
uint256 constant Slot0x80 = 0x80;
uint256 constant Slot0xA0 = 0xa0;
uint256 constant Slot0xC0 = 0xc0;
// abi.encodeWithSignature("transferFrom(address,address,uint256)")
uint256 constant ERC20_transferFrom_signature = (
0x23b872dd00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
uint256 constant ERC20_transferFrom_sig_ptr = 0x0;
uint256 constant ERC20_transferFrom_from_ptr = 0x04;
uint256 constant ERC20_transferFrom_to_ptr = 0x24;
uint256 constant ERC20_transferFrom_amount_ptr = 0x44;
uint256 constant ERC20_transferFrom_length = 0x64; // 4 + 32 * 3 == 100
// abi.encodeWithSignature(
// "safeTransferFrom(address,address,uint256,uint256,bytes)"
// )
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_signature = (
0xf242432a00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_sig_ptr = 0x0;
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_from_ptr = 0x04;
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_to_ptr = 0x24;
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_id_ptr = 0x44;
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_amount_ptr = 0x64;
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_data_offset_ptr = 0x84;
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_data_length_ptr = 0xa4;
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_length = 0xc4; // 4 + 32 * 6 == 196
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeTransferFrom_data_length_offset = 0xa0;
// abi.encodeWithSignature(
// "safeBatchTransferFrom(address,address,uint256[],uint256[],bytes)"
// )
uint256 constant ERC1155_safeBatchTransferFrom_signature = (
0x2eb2c2d600000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
bytes4 constant ERC1155_safeBatchTransferFrom_selector = bytes4(
bytes32(ERC1155_safeBatchTransferFrom_signature)
);
uint256 constant ERC721_transferFrom_signature = ERC20_transferFrom_signature;
uint256 constant ERC721_transferFrom_sig_ptr = 0x0;
uint256 constant ERC721_transferFrom_from_ptr = 0x04;
uint256 constant ERC721_transferFrom_to_ptr = 0x24;
uint256 constant ERC721_transferFrom_id_ptr = 0x44;
uint256 constant ERC721_transferFrom_length = 0x64; // 4 + 32 * 3 == 100
// abi.encodeWithSignature("NoContract(address)")
uint256 constant NoContract_error_signature = (
0x5f15d67200000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
uint256 constant NoContract_error_sig_ptr = 0x0;
uint256 constant NoContract_error_token_ptr = 0x4;
uint256 constant NoContract_error_length = 0x24; // 4 + 32 == 36
// abi.encodeWithSignature(
// "TokenTransferGenericFailure(address,address,address,uint256,uint256)"
// )
uint256 constant TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_signature = (
0xf486bc8700000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
uint256 constant TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_sig_ptr = 0x0;
uint256 constant TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_token_ptr = 0x4;
uint256 constant TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_from_ptr = 0x24;
uint256 constant TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_to_ptr = 0x44;
uint256 constant TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_id_ptr = 0x64;
uint256 constant TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_amount_ptr = 0x84;
// 4 + 32 * 5 == 164
uint256 constant TokenTransferGenericFailure_error_length = 0xa4;
// abi.encodeWithSignature(
// "BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer(address,address,address,uint256)"
// )
uint256 constant BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_signature = (
0x9889192300000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
uint256 constant BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_sig_ptr = 0x0;
uint256 constant BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_token_ptr = 0x4;
uint256 constant BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_from_ptr = 0x24;
uint256 constant BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_to_ptr = 0x44;
uint256 constant BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_amount_ptr = 0x64;
// 4 + 32 * 4 == 132
uint256 constant BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer_error_length = 0x84;
uint256 constant ExtraGasBuffer = 0x20;
uint256 constant CostPerWord = 3;
uint256 constant MemoryExpansionCoefficient = 0x200;
// Values are offset by 32 bytes in order to write the token to the beginning
// in the event of a revert
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_ptr = 0x24;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_ids_head_ptr = 0x64;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_amounts_head_ptr = 0x84;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_data_head_ptr = 0xa4;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_data_length_basePtr = 0xc4;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_calldata_baseSize = 0xc4;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_ids_length_ptr = 0xc4;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_ids_length_offset = 0xa0;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_amounts_length_baseOffset = 0xc0;
uint256 constant BatchTransfer1155Params_data_length_baseOffset = 0xe0;
uint256 constant ConduitBatch1155Transfer_usable_head_size = 0x80;
uint256 constant ConduitBatch1155Transfer_from_offset = 0x20;
uint256 constant ConduitBatch1155Transfer_ids_head_offset = 0x60;
uint256 constant ConduitBatch1155Transfer_amounts_head_offset = 0x80;
uint256 constant ConduitBatch1155Transfer_ids_length_offset = 0xa0;
uint256 constant ConduitBatch1155Transfer_amounts_length_baseOffset = 0xc0;
uint256 constant ConduitBatch1155Transfer_calldata_baseSize = 0xc0;
// Note: abbreviated version of above constant to adhere to line length limit.
uint256 constant ConduitBatchTransfer_amounts_head_offset = 0x80;
uint256 constant Invalid1155BatchTransferEncoding_ptr = 0x00;
uint256 constant Invalid1155BatchTransferEncoding_length = 0x04;
uint256 constant Invalid1155BatchTransferEncoding_selector = (
0xeba2084c00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
uint256 constant ERC1155BatchTransferGenericFailure_error_signature = (
0xafc445e200000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
);
uint256 constant ERC1155BatchTransferGenericFailure_token_ptr = 0x04;
uint256 constant ERC1155BatchTransferGenericFailure_ids_offset = 0xc0;
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
/**
* @title TokenTransferrerErrors
*/
interface TokenTransferrerErrors {
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when an ERC721 transfer with amount other than
* one is attempted.
*/
error InvalidERC721TransferAmount();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to fulfill an order where an
* item has an amount of zero.
*/
error MissingItemAmount();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to fulfill an order where an
* item has unused parameters. This includes both the token and the
* identifier parameters for native transfers as well as the identifier
* parameter for ERC20 transfers. Note that the conduit does not
* perform this check, leaving it up to the calling channel to enforce
* when desired.
*/
error UnusedItemParameters();
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when an ERC20, ERC721, or ERC1155 token
* transfer reverts.
*
* @param token The token for which the transfer was attempted.
* @param from The source of the attempted transfer.
* @param to The recipient of the attempted transfer.
* @param identifier The identifier for the attempted transfer.
* @param amount The amount for the attempted transfer.
*/
error TokenTransferGenericFailure(
address token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 identifier,
uint256 amount
);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when a batch ERC1155 token transfer reverts.
*
* @param token The token for which the transfer was attempted.
* @param from The source of the attempted transfer.
* @param to The recipient of the attempted transfer.
* @param identifiers The identifiers for the attempted transfer.
* @param amounts The amounts for the attempted transfer.
*/
error ERC1155BatchTransferGenericFailure(
address token,
address from,
address to,
uint256[] identifiers,
uint256[] amounts
);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when an ERC20 token transfer returns a falsey
* value.
*
* @param token The token for which the ERC20 transfer was attempted.
* @param from The source of the attempted ERC20 transfer.
* @param to The recipient of the attempted ERC20 transfer.
* @param amount The amount for the attempted ERC20 transfer.
*/
error BadReturnValueFromERC20OnTransfer(
address token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 amount
);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when an account being called as an assumed
* contract does not have code and returns no data.
*
* @param account The account that should contain code.
*/
error NoContract(address account);
/**
* @dev Revert with an error when attempting to execute an 1155 batch
* transfer using calldata not produced by default ABI encoding or with
* different lengths for ids and amounts arrays.
*/
error Invalid1155BatchTransferEncoding();
}
File 2 of 10: SAS
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
_checkOwner();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
*/
function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
/// @notice Optimized and flexible operator filterer to abide to OpenSea's
/// mandatory on-chain royalty enforcement in order for new collections to
/// receive royalties.
/// For more information, see:
/// See: https://github.com/ProjectOpenSea/operator-filter-registry
abstract contract OperatorFilterer {
/// @dev The default OpenSea operator blocklist subscription.
address internal constant _DEFAULT_SUBSCRIPTION = 0x3cc6CddA760b79bAfa08dF41ECFA224f810dCeB6;
/// @dev The OpenSea operator filter registry.
address internal constant _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY = 0x000000000000AAeB6D7670E522A718067333cd4E;
/// @dev Registers the current contract to OpenSea's operator filter,
/// and subscribe to the default OpenSea operator blocklist.
/// Note: Will not revert nor update existing settings for repeated registration.
function _registerForOperatorFiltering() internal virtual {
_registerForOperatorFiltering(_DEFAULT_SUBSCRIPTION, true);
}
/// @dev Registers the current contract to OpenSea's operator filter.
/// Note: Will not revert nor update existing settings for repeated registration.
function _registerForOperatorFiltering(address subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy, bool subscribe)
internal
virtual
{
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
let functionSelector := 0x7d3e3dbe // `registerAndSubscribe(address,address)`.
// Clean the upper 96 bits of `subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy` in case they are dirty.
subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy := shr(96, shl(96, subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy))
for {} iszero(subscribe) {} {
if iszero(subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy) {
functionSelector := 0x4420e486 // `register(address)`.
break
}
functionSelector := 0xa0af2903 // `registerAndCopyEntries(address,address)`.
break
}
// Store the function selector.
mstore(0x00, shl(224, functionSelector))
// Store the `address(this)`.
mstore(0x04, address())
// Store the `subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy`.
mstore(0x24, subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy)
// Register into the registry.
if iszero(call(gas(), _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY, 0, 0x00, 0x44, 0x00, 0x04)) {
// If the function selector has not been overwritten,
// it is an out-of-gas error.
if eq(shr(224, mload(0x00)), functionSelector) {
// To prevent gas under-estimation.
revert(0, 0)
}
}
// Restore the part of the free memory pointer that was overwritten,
// which is guaranteed to be zero, because of Solidity's memory size limits.
mstore(0x24, 0)
}
}
/// @dev Modifier to guard a function and revert if the caller is a blocked operator.
modifier onlyAllowedOperator(address from) virtual {
if (from != msg.sender) {
if (!_isPriorityOperator(msg.sender)) {
if (_operatorFilteringEnabled()) _revertIfBlocked(msg.sender);
}
}
_;
}
/// @dev Modifier to guard a function from approving a blocked operator..
modifier onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(address operator) virtual {
if (!_isPriorityOperator(operator)) {
if (_operatorFilteringEnabled()) _revertIfBlocked(operator);
}
_;
}
/// @dev Helper function that reverts if the `operator` is blocked by the registry.
function _revertIfBlocked(address operator) private view {
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
// Store the function selector of `isOperatorAllowed(address,address)`,
// shifted left by 6 bytes, which is enough for 8tb of memory.
// We waste 6-3 = 3 bytes to save on 6 runtime gas (PUSH1 0x224 SHL).
mstore(0x00, 0xc6171134001122334455)
// Store the `address(this)`.
mstore(0x1a, address())
// Store the `operator`.
mstore(0x3a, operator)
// `isOperatorAllowed` always returns true if it does not revert.
if iszero(staticcall(gas(), _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY, 0x16, 0x44, 0x00, 0x00)) {
// Bubble up the revert if the staticcall reverts.
returndatacopy(0x00, 0x00, returndatasize())
revert(0x00, returndatasize())
}
// We'll skip checking if `from` is inside the blacklist.
// Even though that can block transferring out of wrapper contracts,
// we don't want tokens to be stuck.
// Restore the part of the free memory pointer that was overwritten,
// which is guaranteed to be zero, if less than 8tb of memory is used.
mstore(0x3a, 0)
}
}
/// @dev For deriving contracts to override, so that operator filtering
/// can be turned on / off.
/// Returns true by default.
function _operatorFilteringEnabled() internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return true;
}
/// @dev For deriving contracts to override, so that preferred marketplaces can
/// skip operator filtering, helping users save gas.
/// Returns false for all inputs by default.
function _isPriorityOperator(address) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return false;
}
}
//███████ ██ ███ ██ ███ ██ ███████ ██████ ███████ ██ ███████ █████ ██ ███ ██ ████████ ███████
//██ ██ ████ ██ ████ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ████ ██ ██ ██
//███████ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ █████ ██████ ███████ ████████ ███████ ███████ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ███████
// ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██ ██
//███████ ██ ██ ████ ██ ████ ███████ ██ ██ ███████ ██████ ███████ ██ ██ ██ ██ ████ ██ ███████
// "The old shall die and the older shall rise"
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
// "Do you know who we are? We are from [REDACTED]"
import {Ownable} from "@openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol";
import {ERC721A} from "erc721a/contracts/ERC721A.sol";
import {OperatorFilterer} from "closedsea/src/OperatorFilterer.sol";
// "SAS is [REDACTED] for [REDACTED]"
error PortalNotOpen();
error SummonExceedsMaxSupply();
error FreeSummonLimitReached();
error PaidSummonLimitReached();
error InsufficientPayment();
// "Haha, this must be confusing for you. Don't worry, you'll understand soon enough..."
contract SAS is ERC721A, OperatorFilterer, Ownable {
// Variables
bool public portalOpen = false;
uint256 public MAX_SUPPLY = 8888;
uint256 public PAID_SUMMON_PRICE = 0.005 ether;
uint256 public FREE_SUMMON_LIMIT = 1;
uint256 public PAID_SUMMON_LIMIT = 10;
string public baseURI;
bool public operatorFilteringEnabled;
// "Sacrifice your soul and be born a new. There is beauty in death while ugliness lingers in life. Don't you want to save that equilibrium you always talk about?"
// Constructor
constructor(string memory baseURI_) ERC721A("Sinners & Saints", "SAS") {
_registerForOperatorFiltering();
operatorFilteringEnabled = true;
baseURI = baseURI_;
}
function setApprovalForAll(
address operator,
bool approved
) public override onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator) {
super.setApprovalForAll(operator, approved);
}
function approve(
address operator,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable override onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator) {
super.approve(operator, tokenId);
}
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) {
super.transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) {
super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory data
) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) {
super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, data);
}
function setOperatorFilteringEnabled(bool value) public onlyOwner {
operatorFilteringEnabled = value;
}
function _operatorFilteringEnabled() internal view override returns (bool) {
return operatorFilteringEnabled;
}
// "But, how do I know you aren't lying? You've lied before, and that almost cost me everything..."
// Modifiers
modifier nonContract() {
require(tx.origin == msg.sender, "Contracts not allowed to mint");
_;
}
// Mint
function togglePortal() public onlyOwner {
portalOpen = !portalOpen;
}
function summonFree() external nonContract {
if (!portalOpen) revert PortalNotOpen();
if (_totalMinted() >= MAX_SUPPLY) revert SummonExceedsMaxSupply();
if (_getAux(msg.sender) != 0) revert FreeSummonLimitReached();
_setAux(msg.sender, 1);
_mint(msg.sender, 1);
}
function summonPaid(uint256 qty) external payable nonContract {
if (!portalOpen) revert PortalNotOpen();
if (_totalMinted() + qty > MAX_SUPPLY) revert SummonExceedsMaxSupply();
if (qty > PAID_SUMMON_LIMIT) revert PaidSummonLimitReached();
if (msg.value < qty * PAID_SUMMON_PRICE) revert InsufficientPayment();
_mint(msg.sender, qty);
}
// "Just trust me mortal, you are doing the right thing... Follow me through the flames."
// Token URI
function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return baseURI;
}
function setBaseURI(string memory uri) external onlyOwner {
baseURI = uri;
}
// Withdraw
function withdraw() external onlyOwner {
(bool hs, ) = payable(owner()).call{
value: (address(this).balance * 25) / 100
}("");
require(hs);
(bool os, ) = payable(0x0843EA83EE2E77AFC11C0d1290fd8fA868DB3973).call{
value: address(this).balance
}("");
require(os);
}
}
//Eldrin, an old warrior sat by the fire, his eyes distant as he stared into the flames. He had seen many things in his long years, battles, wars and brutalities that no man should ever have to witness. But nothing had prepared him for the destruction of the delicate equilibrium between sin and faith...
//In the old world, there had been a delicate balance between sin and faith, a balance that allowed people from all walks of life to find their purpose and meaning. But as the balance tipped, the world erupted into chaos, and the corrupted rose from the ground like weeds choking a garden.
//The old warrior had fought against the corrupted, battling their dark magic and twisted armies with his sword and shield. He had seen good men and women fall to corruption and madness, and the world had grown darker and darker with each passing day.
//Now, there were only 8888 warriors left, a small band of brave souls who had dedicated their lives to bringing balance back to the world. Their mission was a daunting one, for they knew that to restore balance, they must first sacrifice themselves.
//The old warrior knew that his time was coming soon, that he would join the ranks of the fallen who had given their lives for this cause. But he would do so with the knowledge that he had fought for something greater than himself, that he had stood for balance and justice in a world that sorely needed it.
//As the flames flickered and danced, the old warrior steeled himself for the battle to come. He would face the corrupted with all the strength he had left, knowing that his sacrifice would be one small step in the journey to restore the balance that had been lost.
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import './IERC721A.sol';
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
*/
interface ERC721A__IERC721Receiver {
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
/**
* @title ERC721A
*
* @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
* Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
* Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
*
* Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
* starting from `_startTokenId()`.
*
* Assumptions:
*
* - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
* - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
*/
contract ERC721A is IERC721A {
// Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
struct TokenApprovalRef {
address value;
}
// =============================================================
// CONSTANTS
// =============================================================
// Mask of an entry in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
// The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
// The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
// The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
// Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
// The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
// The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
// The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
// The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
// The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
// Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
// The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
// The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
// This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
// For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
// is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
// The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
// `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
// =============================================================
// STORAGE
// =============================================================
// The next token ID to be minted.
uint256 private _currentIndex;
// The number of tokens burned.
uint256 private _burnCounter;
// Token name
string private _name;
// Token symbol
string private _symbol;
// Mapping from token ID to ownership details
// An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
// See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..159] `addr`
// - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
// - [224] `burned`
// - [225] `nextInitialized`
// - [232..255] `extraData`
mapping(uint256 => uint256) private _packedOwnerships;
// Mapping owner address to address data.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..63] `balance`
// - [64..127] `numberMinted`
// - [128..191] `numberBurned`
// - [192..255] `aux`
mapping(address => uint256) private _packedAddressData;
// Mapping from token ID to approved address.
mapping(uint256 => TokenApprovalRef) private _tokenApprovals;
// Mapping from owner to operator approvals
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
// =============================================================
// CONSTRUCTOR
// =============================================================
constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
_name = name_;
_symbol = symbol_;
_currentIndex = _startTokenId();
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the starting token ID.
* To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
*/
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
*/
function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return _currentIndex;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
// more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
*/
function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
// and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
*/
function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return _burnCounter;
}
// =============================================================
// ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
return _packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
*/
function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
*/
function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
*/
function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
return uint64(_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
}
/**
* Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
* If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
*/
function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = _packedAddressData[owner];
uint256 auxCasted;
// Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
auxCasted := aux
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
_packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
}
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
// The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
// of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
// See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
// (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
return
interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
}
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _name;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _symbol;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : '';
}
/**
* @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
* token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
* by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return '';
}
// =============================================================
// OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
}
/**
* @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
* It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
*/
function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
*/
function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnerships[index]);
}
/**
* @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
*/
function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
if (_packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
_packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
}
}
/**
* Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
*/
function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256) {
uint256 curr = tokenId;
unchecked {
if (_startTokenId() <= curr)
if (curr < _currentIndex) {
uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[curr];
// If not burned.
if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) {
// Invariant:
// There will always be an initialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// before an unintialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// Hence, `curr` will not underflow.
//
// We can directly compare the packed value.
// If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
while (packed == 0) {
packed = _packedOwnerships[--curr];
}
return packed;
}
}
}
revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
*/
function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
}
/**
* @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
*/
function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
*/
function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
// For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
assembly {
// `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
}
}
// =============================================================
// APPROVAL OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
return _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
}
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
_operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
}
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
*
* Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
*/
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return
_startTokenId() <= tokenId &&
tokenId < _currentIndex && // If within bounds,
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned.
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
*/
function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
address approvedAddress,
address owner,
address msgSender
) private pure returns (bool result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
*/
function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId)
private
view
returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress)
{
TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
// The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
assembly {
approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
}
}
// =============================================================
// TRANSFER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
--_packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
++_packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
// Updates:
// - `address` to the next owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
}
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public payable virtual override {
transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
if (to.code.length != 0)
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called before burning one token.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* have been transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called after one token has been burned.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _afterTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
*
* `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
* `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
* `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
* `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
*
* Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
*/
function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
try ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (
bytes4 retval
) {
return retval == ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
// =============================================================
// MINT OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
// `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
_packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
_packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
uint256 toMasked;
uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
// Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings.
// The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling.
// The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been
// delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes.
assembly {
// Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Emit the `Transfer` event.
log4(
0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
0, // End of data (0, since no data).
_TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
0, // `address(0)`.
toMasked, // `to`.
startTokenId // `tokenId`.
)
// The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
// that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
// The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance.
for {
let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1)
} iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) {
tokenId := add(tokenId, 1)
} {
// Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above.
log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId)
}
}
if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress();
_currentIndex = end;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
*
* It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
* instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
*
* Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
* non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
* For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
* {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
*/
function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
_packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
_packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
_currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* See {_mint}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data
) internal virtual {
_mint(to, quantity);
unchecked {
if (to.code.length != 0) {
uint256 end = _currentIndex;
uint256 index = end - quantity;
do {
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
} while (index < end);
// Reentrancy protection.
if (_currentIndex != end) revert();
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
*/
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
_safeMint(to, quantity, '');
}
// =============================================================
// BURN OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
* The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
if (approvalCheck) {
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance -= 1`.
// - `numberBurned += 1`.
//
// We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
// This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
_packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
// Updates:
// - `address` to the last owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
// - `burned` to `true`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
from,
(_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
unchecked {
_burnCounter++;
}
}
// =============================================================
// EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
*/
function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[index];
if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
uint256 extraDataCasted;
// Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
extraDataCasted := extraData
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
_packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
}
/**
* @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
* Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
*
* `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _extraData(
address from,
address to,
uint24 previousExtraData
) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
/**
* @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
* The returned result is shifted into position.
*/
function _nextExtraData(
address from,
address to,
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked
) private view returns (uint256) {
uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
}
// =============================================================
// OTHER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
*
* If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
*/
function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
/**
* @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
*/
function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
assembly {
// The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
// we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
// We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
// and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
// Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
mstore(0x40, m)
// Assign the `str` to the end.
str := sub(m, 0x20)
// Zeroize the slot after the string.
mstore(str, 0)
// Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
let end := str
// We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
// The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
// prettier-ignore
for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
str := sub(str, 1)
// Write the character to the pointer.
// The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
// Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
temp := div(temp, 10)
// prettier-ignore
if iszero(temp) { break }
}
let length := sub(end, str)
// Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
str := sub(str, 0x20)
// Store the length.
mstore(str, length)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721A.
*/
interface IERC721A {
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
*/
error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
/**
* Cannot mint to the zero address.
*/
error MintToZeroAddress();
/**
* The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
*/
error MintZeroQuantity();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token must be owned by `from`.
*/
error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
/**
* Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
* ERC721Receiver interface.
*/
error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
/**
* Cannot transfer to the zero address.
*/
error TransferToZeroAddress();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
*/
error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
/**
* The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
*/
error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
// =============================================================
// STRUCTS
// =============================================================
struct TokenOwnership {
// The address of the owner.
address addr;
// Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 startTimestamp;
// Whether the token has been burned.
bool burned;
// Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
uint24 extraData;
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTERS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
* (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
* checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
* to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
* this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
* whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
// =============================================================
// IERC2309
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
* (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
*
* See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
*/
event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
}
File 3 of 10: BoredPunksYachtClub
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
_checkOwner();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
*/
function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity 0.8.17;
import "erc721a/contracts/ERC721A.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol";
import "operator-filter-registry/src/DefaultOperatorFilterer.sol";
contract BoredPunksYachtClub is
ERC721A("Bored Punks Yacht Club", "BPYC"),
DefaultOperatorFilterer,
Ownable
{
// Storage
string public uriPrefix = "";
string public uriSuffix = ".json";
string public hiddenMetadataUri = "ipfs://QmUdNpqxrWPqxofkp3V24PjRAwwoVZwFMVm8R48vM7Wn8R/";
uint256 public cost = 0.004 ether;
uint256 public maxSupply = 10000;
uint256 public maxPerWallet = 11;
uint256 public maxFreePerWallet = 1;
bool public paused = true;
bool public revealed = false;
// Constants
address public constant ADMIN_ONE = 0xC0EE5401DbaDBcf2142B722d916eED9dDE03939D;
address public constant ADMIN_TWO = 0xEf58d656c7A1710A0A83fC8B706B6b92a9364cDb;
// Modifiers
modifier mintCompliance(uint256 _mintAmount) {
require(msg.sender == tx.origin, "No contracts allowed!");
require(_mintAmount > 0, "You can't mint 0 punks!");
require(
_numberMinted(_msgSender()) + _mintAmount <= maxPerWallet,
"You can't mint more than 11 punks per wallet!"
);
require(
totalSupply() + _mintAmount <= maxSupply,
"Those damn punks took everything we had!"
);
_;
}
modifier mintPriceCompliance(uint256 _mintAmount) {
uint256 totalCost = cost * _mintAmount;
if (_numberMinted(_msgSender()) < maxFreePerWallet) {
totalCost = totalCost - cost;
}
require(msg.value >= totalCost, "Hey PUNK! You've got to pay for that!");
_;
}
// Main mint function
function mint(
uint256 _mintAmount
) public payable mintCompliance(_mintAmount) mintPriceCompliance(_mintAmount) {
require(!paused, "Come back soon PUNK!");
_safeMint(_msgSender(), _mintAmount);
}
// Metadata Reveal Override
function tokenURI(uint256 _tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
require(_exists(_tokenId), "ERC721Metadata: URI query for nonexistent token");
if (revealed == false) {
return hiddenMetadataUri;
}
string memory currentBaseURI = _baseURI();
return
bytes(currentBaseURI).length > 0
? string(abi.encodePacked(currentBaseURI, _toString(_tokenId), uriSuffix))
: "";
}
// Admin Functions
function mintForAddress(uint256 _mintAmount, address _receiver) public onlyOwner {
require(totalSupply() + _mintAmount <= maxSupply, "Max supply exceeded!");
_safeMint(_receiver, _mintAmount);
}
function setRevealed(bool _state) public onlyOwner {
revealed = _state;
}
function setCost(uint256 _cost) public onlyOwner {
cost = _cost;
}
function setMaxPerWallet(uint256 max) public onlyOwner {
maxPerWallet = max;
}
function setHiddenMetadataUri(string memory _hiddenMetadataUri) public onlyOwner {
hiddenMetadataUri = _hiddenMetadataUri;
}
function setUriPrefix(string memory _uriPrefix) public onlyOwner {
uriPrefix = _uriPrefix;
}
function setUriSuffix(string memory _uriSuffix) public onlyOwner {
uriSuffix = _uriSuffix;
}
function setPaused(bool _state) public onlyOwner {
paused = _state;
}
function withdraw() external onlyOwner {
(bool success, ) = ADMIN_ONE.call{value: address(this).balance / 2}("");
require(success, "Transfer failed.");
(bool secondSucces, ) = ADMIN_TWO.call{value: address(this).balance}("");
require(secondSucces, "Second Transfer failed.");
}
// Opensea OperatorFilterer Overrides
function setApprovalForAll(
address operator,
bool approved
) public override onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator) {
super.setApprovalForAll(operator, approved);
}
function approve(
address operator,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable override onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator) {
super.approve(operator, tokenId);
}
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) {
super.transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) {
super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory data
) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) {
super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, data);
}
// Internal Overrides
function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return uriPrefix;
}
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual override returns (uint256) {
return 1;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import './IERC721A.sol';
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
*/
interface ERC721A__IERC721Receiver {
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
/**
* @title ERC721A
*
* @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
* Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
* Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
*
* Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
* starting from `_startTokenId()`.
*
* Assumptions:
*
* - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
* - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
*/
contract ERC721A is IERC721A {
// Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
struct TokenApprovalRef {
address value;
}
// =============================================================
// CONSTANTS
// =============================================================
// Mask of an entry in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
// The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
// The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
// The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
// Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
// The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
// The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
// The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
// The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
// The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
// Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
// The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
// The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
// This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
// For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
// is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
// The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
// `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
// =============================================================
// STORAGE
// =============================================================
// The next token ID to be minted.
uint256 private _currentIndex;
// The number of tokens burned.
uint256 private _burnCounter;
// Token name
string private _name;
// Token symbol
string private _symbol;
// Mapping from token ID to ownership details
// An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
// See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..159] `addr`
// - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
// - [224] `burned`
// - [225] `nextInitialized`
// - [232..255] `extraData`
mapping(uint256 => uint256) private _packedOwnerships;
// Mapping owner address to address data.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..63] `balance`
// - [64..127] `numberMinted`
// - [128..191] `numberBurned`
// - [192..255] `aux`
mapping(address => uint256) private _packedAddressData;
// Mapping from token ID to approved address.
mapping(uint256 => TokenApprovalRef) private _tokenApprovals;
// Mapping from owner to operator approvals
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
// =============================================================
// CONSTRUCTOR
// =============================================================
constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
_name = name_;
_symbol = symbol_;
_currentIndex = _startTokenId();
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the starting token ID.
* To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
*/
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
*/
function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return _currentIndex;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
// more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
*/
function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
// and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
*/
function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return _burnCounter;
}
// =============================================================
// ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
return _packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
*/
function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
*/
function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
*/
function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
return uint64(_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
}
/**
* Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
* If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
*/
function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = _packedAddressData[owner];
uint256 auxCasted;
// Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
auxCasted := aux
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
_packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
}
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
// The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
// of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
// See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
// (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
return
interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
}
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _name;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _symbol;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : '';
}
/**
* @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
* token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
* by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return '';
}
// =============================================================
// OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
}
/**
* @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
* It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
*/
function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
*/
function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnerships[index]);
}
/**
* @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
*/
function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
if (_packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
_packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
}
}
/**
* Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
*/
function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256) {
uint256 curr = tokenId;
unchecked {
if (_startTokenId() <= curr)
if (curr < _currentIndex) {
uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[curr];
// If not burned.
if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) {
// Invariant:
// There will always be an initialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// before an unintialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// Hence, `curr` will not underflow.
//
// We can directly compare the packed value.
// If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
while (packed == 0) {
packed = _packedOwnerships[--curr];
}
return packed;
}
}
}
revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
*/
function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
}
/**
* @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
*/
function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
*/
function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
// For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
assembly {
// `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
}
}
// =============================================================
// APPROVAL OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
return _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
}
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
_operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
}
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
*
* Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
*/
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return
_startTokenId() <= tokenId &&
tokenId < _currentIndex && // If within bounds,
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned.
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
*/
function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
address approvedAddress,
address owner,
address msgSender
) private pure returns (bool result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
*/
function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId)
private
view
returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress)
{
TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
// The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
assembly {
approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
}
}
// =============================================================
// TRANSFER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
--_packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
++_packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
// Updates:
// - `address` to the next owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
}
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public payable virtual override {
transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
if (to.code.length != 0)
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called before burning one token.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* have been transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called after one token has been burned.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _afterTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
*
* `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
* `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
* `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
* `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
*
* Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
*/
function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
try ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (
bytes4 retval
) {
return retval == ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
// =============================================================
// MINT OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
// `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
_packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
_packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
uint256 toMasked;
uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
// Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings.
// The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling.
// The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been
// delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes.
assembly {
// Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Emit the `Transfer` event.
log4(
0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
0, // End of data (0, since no data).
_TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
0, // `address(0)`.
toMasked, // `to`.
startTokenId // `tokenId`.
)
// The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
// that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
// The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance.
for {
let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1)
} iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) {
tokenId := add(tokenId, 1)
} {
// Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above.
log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId)
}
}
if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress();
_currentIndex = end;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
*
* It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
* instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
*
* Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
* non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
* For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
* {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
*/
function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
_packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
_packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
_currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* See {_mint}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data
) internal virtual {
_mint(to, quantity);
unchecked {
if (to.code.length != 0) {
uint256 end = _currentIndex;
uint256 index = end - quantity;
do {
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
} while (index < end);
// Reentrancy protection.
if (_currentIndex != end) revert();
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
*/
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
_safeMint(to, quantity, '');
}
// =============================================================
// BURN OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
* The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
if (approvalCheck) {
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance -= 1`.
// - `numberBurned += 1`.
//
// We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
// This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
_packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
// Updates:
// - `address` to the last owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
// - `burned` to `true`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
from,
(_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
unchecked {
_burnCounter++;
}
}
// =============================================================
// EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
*/
function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[index];
if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
uint256 extraDataCasted;
// Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
extraDataCasted := extraData
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
_packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
}
/**
* @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
* Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
*
* `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _extraData(
address from,
address to,
uint24 previousExtraData
) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
/**
* @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
* The returned result is shifted into position.
*/
function _nextExtraData(
address from,
address to,
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked
) private view returns (uint256) {
uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
}
// =============================================================
// OTHER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
*
* If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
*/
function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
/**
* @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
*/
function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
assembly {
// The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
// we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
// We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
// and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
// Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
mstore(0x40, m)
// Assign the `str` to the end.
str := sub(m, 0x20)
// Zeroize the slot after the string.
mstore(str, 0)
// Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
let end := str
// We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
// The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
// prettier-ignore
for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
str := sub(str, 1)
// Write the character to the pointer.
// The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
// Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
temp := div(temp, 10)
// prettier-ignore
if iszero(temp) { break }
}
let length := sub(end, str)
// Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
str := sub(str, 0x20)
// Store the length.
mstore(str, length)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721A.
*/
interface IERC721A {
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
*/
error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
/**
* Cannot mint to the zero address.
*/
error MintToZeroAddress();
/**
* The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
*/
error MintZeroQuantity();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token must be owned by `from`.
*/
error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
/**
* Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
* ERC721Receiver interface.
*/
error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
/**
* Cannot transfer to the zero address.
*/
error TransferToZeroAddress();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
*/
error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
/**
* The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
*/
error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
// =============================================================
// STRUCTS
// =============================================================
struct TokenOwnership {
// The address of the owner.
address addr;
// Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 startTimestamp;
// Whether the token has been burned.
bool burned;
// Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
uint24 extraData;
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTERS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
* (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
* checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
* to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
* this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
* whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
// =============================================================
// IERC2309
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
* (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
*
* See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
*/
event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
import {OperatorFilterer} from "./OperatorFilterer.sol";
/**
* @title DefaultOperatorFilterer
* @notice Inherits from OperatorFilterer and automatically subscribes to the default OpenSea subscription.
*/
abstract contract DefaultOperatorFilterer is OperatorFilterer {
address constant DEFAULT_SUBSCRIPTION = address(0x3cc6CddA760b79bAfa08dF41ECFA224f810dCeB6);
constructor() OperatorFilterer(DEFAULT_SUBSCRIPTION, true) {}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
interface IOperatorFilterRegistry {
function isOperatorAllowed(address registrant, address operator) external view returns (bool);
function register(address registrant) external;
function registerAndSubscribe(address registrant, address subscription) external;
function registerAndCopyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function unregister(address addr) external;
function updateOperator(address registrant, address operator, bool filtered) external;
function updateOperators(address registrant, address[] calldata operators, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHash(address registrant, bytes32 codehash, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHashes(address registrant, bytes32[] calldata codeHashes, bool filtered) external;
function subscribe(address registrant, address registrantToSubscribe) external;
function unsubscribe(address registrant, bool copyExistingEntries) external;
function subscriptionOf(address addr) external returns (address registrant);
function subscribers(address registrant) external returns (address[] memory);
function subscriberAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function copyEntriesOf(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function isOperatorFiltered(address registrant, address operator) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashOfFiltered(address registrant, address operatorWithCode) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashFiltered(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash) external returns (bool);
function filteredOperators(address addr) external returns (address[] memory);
function filteredCodeHashes(address addr) external returns (bytes32[] memory);
function filteredOperatorAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function filteredCodeHashAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (bytes32);
function isRegistered(address addr) external returns (bool);
function codeHashOf(address addr) external returns (bytes32);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
import {IOperatorFilterRegistry} from "./IOperatorFilterRegistry.sol";
/**
* @title OperatorFilterer
* @notice Abstract contract whose constructor automatically registers and optionally subscribes to or copies another
* registrant's entries in the OperatorFilterRegistry.
* @dev This smart contract is meant to be inherited by token contracts so they can use the following:
* - `onlyAllowedOperator` modifier for `transferFrom` and `safeTransferFrom` methods.
* - `onlyAllowedOperatorApproval` modifier for `approve` and `setApprovalForAll` methods.
*/
abstract contract OperatorFilterer {
error OperatorNotAllowed(address operator);
IOperatorFilterRegistry public constant OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY =
IOperatorFilterRegistry(0x000000000000AAeB6D7670E522A718067333cd4E);
constructor(address subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy, bool subscribe) {
// If an inheriting token contract is deployed to a network without the registry deployed, the modifier
// will not revert, but the contract will need to be registered with the registry once it is deployed in
// order for the modifier to filter addresses.
if (address(OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY).code.length > 0) {
if (subscribe) {
OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY.registerAndSubscribe(address(this), subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy);
} else {
if (subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy != address(0)) {
OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY.registerAndCopyEntries(address(this), subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy);
} else {
OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY.register(address(this));
}
}
}
}
modifier onlyAllowedOperator(address from) virtual {
// Allow spending tokens from addresses with balance
// Note that this still allows listings and marketplaces with escrow to transfer tokens if transferred
// from an EOA.
if (from != msg.sender) {
_checkFilterOperator(msg.sender);
}
_;
}
modifier onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(address operator) virtual {
_checkFilterOperator(operator);
_;
}
function _checkFilterOperator(address operator) internal view virtual {
// Check registry code length to facilitate testing in environments without a deployed registry.
if (address(OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY).code.length > 0) {
if (!OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY.isOperatorAllowed(address(this), operator)) {
revert OperatorNotAllowed(operator);
}
}
}
}
File 4 of 10: DegenWarriors
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev These functions deal with verification of Merkle Tree proofs.
*
* The tree and the proofs can be generated using our
* https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/merkle-tree[JavaScript library].
* You will find a quickstart guide in the readme.
*
* WARNING: You should avoid using leaf values that are 64 bytes long prior to
* hashing, or use a hash function other than keccak256 for hashing leaves.
* This is because the concatenation of a sorted pair of internal nodes in
* the merkle tree could be reinterpreted as a leaf value.
* OpenZeppelin's JavaScript library generates merkle trees that are safe
* against this attack out of the box.
*/
library MerkleProof {
/**
* @dev Returns true if a `leaf` can be proved to be a part of a Merkle tree
* defined by `root`. For this, a `proof` must be provided, containing
* sibling hashes on the branch from the leaf to the root of the tree. Each
* pair of leaves and each pair of pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*/
function verify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processProof(proof, leaf) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {verify}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function verifyCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processProofCalldata(proof, leaf) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the rebuilt hash obtained by traversing a Merkle tree up
* from `leaf` using `proof`. A `proof` is valid if and only if the rebuilt
* hash matches the root of the tree. When processing the proof, the pairs
* of leafs & pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*
* _Available since v4.4._
*/
function processProof(bytes32[] memory proof, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
computedHash = _hashPair(computedHash, proof[i]);
}
return computedHash;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {processProof}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processProofCalldata(bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
computedHash = _hashPair(computedHash, proof[i]);
}
return computedHash;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the `leaves` can be simultaneously proven to be a part of a merkle tree defined by
* `root`, according to `proof` and `proofFlags` as described in {processMultiProof}.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function multiProofVerify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bool[] memory proofFlags,
bytes32 root,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processMultiProof(proof, proofFlags, leaves) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {multiProofVerify}
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function multiProofVerifyCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bool[] calldata proofFlags,
bytes32 root,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processMultiProofCalldata(proof, proofFlags, leaves) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the root of a tree reconstructed from `leaves` and sibling nodes in `proof`. The reconstruction
* proceeds by incrementally reconstructing all inner nodes by combining a leaf/inner node with either another
* leaf/inner node or a proof sibling node, depending on whether each `proofFlags` item is true or false
* respectively.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. To use multiproofs, it is sufficient to ensure that: 1) the tree
* is complete (but not necessarily perfect), 2) the leaves to be proven are in the opposite order they are in the
* tree (i.e., as seen from right to left starting at the deepest layer and continuing at the next layer).
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processMultiProof(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bool[] memory proofFlags,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bytes32 merkleRoot) {
// This function rebuild the root hash by traversing the tree up from the leaves. The root is rebuilt by
// consuming and producing values on a queue. The queue starts with the `leaves` array, then goes onto the
// `hashes` array. At the end of the process, the last hash in the `hashes` array should contain the root of
// the merkle tree.
uint256 leavesLen = leaves.length;
uint256 totalHashes = proofFlags.length;
// Check proof validity.
require(leavesLen + proof.length - 1 == totalHashes, "MerkleProof: invalid multiproof");
// The xxxPos values are "pointers" to the next value to consume in each array. All accesses are done using
// `xxx[xxxPos++]`, which return the current value and increment the pointer, thus mimicking a queue's "pop".
bytes32[] memory hashes = new bytes32[](totalHashes);
uint256 leafPos = 0;
uint256 hashPos = 0;
uint256 proofPos = 0;
// At each step, we compute the next hash using two values:
// - a value from the "main queue". If not all leaves have been consumed, we get the next leaf, otherwise we
// get the next hash.
// - depending on the flag, either another value for the "main queue" (merging branches) or an element from the
// `proof` array.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalHashes; i++) {
bytes32 a = leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++];
bytes32 b = proofFlags[i] ? leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++] : proof[proofPos++];
hashes[i] = _hashPair(a, b);
}
if (totalHashes > 0) {
return hashes[totalHashes - 1];
} else if (leavesLen > 0) {
return leaves[0];
} else {
return proof[0];
}
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {processMultiProof}.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processMultiProofCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bool[] calldata proofFlags,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bytes32 merkleRoot) {
// This function rebuild the root hash by traversing the tree up from the leaves. The root is rebuilt by
// consuming and producing values on a queue. The queue starts with the `leaves` array, then goes onto the
// `hashes` array. At the end of the process, the last hash in the `hashes` array should contain the root of
// the merkle tree.
uint256 leavesLen = leaves.length;
uint256 totalHashes = proofFlags.length;
// Check proof validity.
require(leavesLen + proof.length - 1 == totalHashes, "MerkleProof: invalid multiproof");
// The xxxPos values are "pointers" to the next value to consume in each array. All accesses are done using
// `xxx[xxxPos++]`, which return the current value and increment the pointer, thus mimicking a queue's "pop".
bytes32[] memory hashes = new bytes32[](totalHashes);
uint256 leafPos = 0;
uint256 hashPos = 0;
uint256 proofPos = 0;
// At each step, we compute the next hash using two values:
// - a value from the "main queue". If not all leaves have been consumed, we get the next leaf, otherwise we
// get the next hash.
// - depending on the flag, either another value for the "main queue" (merging branches) or an element from the
// `proof` array.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalHashes; i++) {
bytes32 a = leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++];
bytes32 b = proofFlags[i] ? leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++] : proof[proofPos++];
hashes[i] = _hashPair(a, b);
}
if (totalHashes > 0) {
return hashes[totalHashes - 1];
} else if (leavesLen > 0) {
return leaves[0];
} else {
return proof[0];
}
}
function _hashPair(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32) {
return a < b ? _efficientHash(a, b) : _efficientHash(b, a);
}
function _efficientHash(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32 value) {
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
mstore(0x00, a)
mstore(0x20, b)
value := keccak256(0x00, 0x40)
}
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/math/Math.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/math/Math.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Standard math utilities missing in the Solidity language.
*/
library Math {
enum Rounding {
Down, // Toward negative infinity
Up, // Toward infinity
Zero // Toward zero
}
/**
* @dev Returns the largest of two numbers.
*/
function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a > b ? a : b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers.
*/
function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a < b ? a : b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the average of two numbers. The result is rounded towards
* zero.
*/
function average(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
// (a + b) / 2 can overflow.
return (a & b) + (a ^ b) / 2;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the ceiling of the division of two numbers.
*
* This differs from standard division with `/` in that it rounds up instead
* of rounding down.
*/
function ceilDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
// (a + b - 1) / b can overflow on addition, so we distribute.
return a == 0 ? 0 : (a - 1) / b + 1;
}
/**
* @notice Calculates floor(x * y / denominator) with full precision. Throws if result overflows a uint256 or denominator == 0
* @dev Original credit to Remco Bloemen under MIT license (https://xn--2-umb.com/21/muldiv)
* with further edits by Uniswap Labs also under MIT license.
*/
function mulDiv(
uint256 x,
uint256 y,
uint256 denominator
) internal pure returns (uint256 result) {
unchecked {
// 512-bit multiply [prod1 prod0] = x * y. Compute the product mod 2^256 and mod 2^256 - 1, then use
// use the Chinese Remainder Theorem to reconstruct the 512 bit result. The result is stored in two 256
// variables such that product = prod1 * 2^256 + prod0.
uint256 prod0; // Least significant 256 bits of the product
uint256 prod1; // Most significant 256 bits of the product
assembly {
let mm := mulmod(x, y, not(0))
prod0 := mul(x, y)
prod1 := sub(sub(mm, prod0), lt(mm, prod0))
}
// Handle non-overflow cases, 256 by 256 division.
if (prod1 == 0) {
return prod0 / denominator;
}
// Make sure the result is less than 2^256. Also prevents denominator == 0.
require(denominator > prod1);
///////////////////////////////////////////////
// 512 by 256 division.
///////////////////////////////////////////////
// Make division exact by subtracting the remainder from [prod1 prod0].
uint256 remainder;
assembly {
// Compute remainder using mulmod.
remainder := mulmod(x, y, denominator)
// Subtract 256 bit number from 512 bit number.
prod1 := sub(prod1, gt(remainder, prod0))
prod0 := sub(prod0, remainder)
}
// Factor powers of two out of denominator and compute largest power of two divisor of denominator. Always >= 1.
// See https://cs.stackexchange.com/q/138556/92363.
// Does not overflow because the denominator cannot be zero at this stage in the function.
uint256 twos = denominator & (~denominator + 1);
assembly {
// Divide denominator by twos.
denominator := div(denominator, twos)
// Divide [prod1 prod0] by twos.
prod0 := div(prod0, twos)
// Flip twos such that it is 2^256 / twos. If twos is zero, then it becomes one.
twos := add(div(sub(0, twos), twos), 1)
}
// Shift in bits from prod1 into prod0.
prod0 |= prod1 * twos;
// Invert denominator mod 2^256. Now that denominator is an odd number, it has an inverse modulo 2^256 such
// that denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^256. Compute the inverse by starting with a seed that is correct for
// four bits. That is, denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^4.
uint256 inverse = (3 * denominator) ^ 2;
// Use the Newton-Raphson iteration to improve the precision. Thanks to Hensel's lifting lemma, this also works
// in modular arithmetic, doubling the correct bits in each step.
inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^8
inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^16
inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^32
inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^64
inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^128
inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^256
// Because the division is now exact we can divide by multiplying with the modular inverse of denominator.
// This will give us the correct result modulo 2^256. Since the preconditions guarantee that the outcome is
// less than 2^256, this is the final result. We don't need to compute the high bits of the result and prod1
// is no longer required.
result = prod0 * inverse;
return result;
}
}
/**
* @notice Calculates x * y / denominator with full precision, following the selected rounding direction.
*/
function mulDiv(
uint256 x,
uint256 y,
uint256 denominator,
Rounding rounding
) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 result = mulDiv(x, y, denominator);
if (rounding == Rounding.Up && mulmod(x, y, denominator) > 0) {
result += 1;
}
return result;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the square root of a number. If the number is not a perfect square, the value is rounded down.
*
* Inspired by Henry S. Warren, Jr.'s "Hacker's Delight" (Chapter 11).
*/
function sqrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint256) {
if (a == 0) {
return 0;
}
// For our first guess, we get the biggest power of 2 which is smaller than the square root of the target.
//
// We know that the "msb" (most significant bit) of our target number `a` is a power of 2 such that we have
// `msb(a) <= a < 2*msb(a)`. This value can be written `msb(a)=2**k` with `k=log2(a)`.
//
// This can be rewritten `2**log2(a) <= a < 2**(log2(a) + 1)`
// → `sqrt(2**k) <= sqrt(a) < sqrt(2**(k+1))`
// → `2**(k/2) <= sqrt(a) < 2**((k+1)/2) <= 2**(k/2 + 1)`
//
// Consequently, `2**(log2(a) / 2)` is a good first approximation of `sqrt(a)` with at least 1 correct bit.
uint256 result = 1 << (log2(a) >> 1);
// At this point `result` is an estimation with one bit of precision. We know the true value is a uint128,
// since it is the square root of a uint256. Newton's method converges quadratically (precision doubles at
// every iteration). We thus need at most 7 iteration to turn our partial result with one bit of precision
// into the expected uint128 result.
unchecked {
result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
return min(result, a / result);
}
}
/**
* @notice Calculates sqrt(a), following the selected rounding direction.
*/
function sqrt(uint256 a, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
unchecked {
uint256 result = sqrt(a);
return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && result * result < a ? 1 : 0);
}
}
/**
* @dev Return the log in base 2, rounded down, of a positive value.
* Returns 0 if given 0.
*/
function log2(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 result = 0;
unchecked {
if (value >> 128 > 0) {
value >>= 128;
result += 128;
}
if (value >> 64 > 0) {
value >>= 64;
result += 64;
}
if (value >> 32 > 0) {
value >>= 32;
result += 32;
}
if (value >> 16 > 0) {
value >>= 16;
result += 16;
}
if (value >> 8 > 0) {
value >>= 8;
result += 8;
}
if (value >> 4 > 0) {
value >>= 4;
result += 4;
}
if (value >> 2 > 0) {
value >>= 2;
result += 2;
}
if (value >> 1 > 0) {
result += 1;
}
}
return result;
}
/**
* @dev Return the log in base 2, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
* Returns 0 if given 0.
*/
function log2(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
unchecked {
uint256 result = log2(value);
return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << result < value ? 1 : 0);
}
}
/**
* @dev Return the log in base 10, rounded down, of a positive value.
* Returns 0 if given 0.
*/
function log10(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 result = 0;
unchecked {
if (value >= 10**64) {
value /= 10**64;
result += 64;
}
if (value >= 10**32) {
value /= 10**32;
result += 32;
}
if (value >= 10**16) {
value /= 10**16;
result += 16;
}
if (value >= 10**8) {
value /= 10**8;
result += 8;
}
if (value >= 10**4) {
value /= 10**4;
result += 4;
}
if (value >= 10**2) {
value /= 10**2;
result += 2;
}
if (value >= 10**1) {
result += 1;
}
}
return result;
}
/**
* @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
* Returns 0 if given 0.
*/
function log10(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
unchecked {
uint256 result = log10(value);
return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 10**result < value ? 1 : 0);
}
}
/**
* @dev Return the log in base 256, rounded down, of a positive value.
* Returns 0 if given 0.
*
* Adding one to the result gives the number of pairs of hex symbols needed to represent `value` as a hex string.
*/
function log256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 result = 0;
unchecked {
if (value >> 128 > 0) {
value >>= 128;
result += 16;
}
if (value >> 64 > 0) {
value >>= 64;
result += 8;
}
if (value >> 32 > 0) {
value >>= 32;
result += 4;
}
if (value >> 16 > 0) {
value >>= 16;
result += 2;
}
if (value >> 8 > 0) {
result += 1;
}
}
return result;
}
/**
* @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
* Returns 0 if given 0.
*/
function log256(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
unchecked {
uint256 result = log256(value);
return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << (result * 8) < value ? 1 : 0);
}
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Strings.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Strings.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev String operations.
*/
library Strings {
bytes16 private constant _SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
uint8 private constant _ADDRESS_LENGTH = 20;
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
*/
function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
unchecked {
uint256 length = Math.log10(value) + 1;
string memory buffer = new string(length);
uint256 ptr;
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
ptr := add(buffer, add(32, length))
}
while (true) {
ptr--;
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
mstore8(ptr, byte(mod(value, 10), _SYMBOLS))
}
value /= 10;
if (value == 0) break;
}
return buffer;
}
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
unchecked {
return toHexString(value, Math.log256(value) + 1);
}
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
buffer[0] = "0";
buffer[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
buffer[i] = _SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
value >>= 4;
}
require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts an `address` with fixed length of 20 bytes to its not checksummed ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(address addr) internal pure returns (string memory) {
return toHexString(uint256(uint160(addr)), _ADDRESS_LENGTH);
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/math/SafeMath.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (utils/math/SafeMath.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
// CAUTION
// This version of SafeMath should only be used with Solidity 0.8 or later,
// because it relies on the compiler's built in overflow checks.
/**
* @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations.
*
* NOTE: `SafeMath` is generally not needed starting with Solidity 0.8, since the compiler
* now has built in overflow checking.
*/
library SafeMath {
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryAdd(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
unchecked {
uint256 c = a + b;
if (c < a) return (false, 0);
return (true, c);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function trySub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
unchecked {
if (b > a) return (false, 0);
return (true, a - b);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryMul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
unchecked {
// Gas optimization: this is cheaper than requiring 'a' not being zero, but the
// benefit is lost if 'b' is also tested.
// See: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/pull/522
if (a == 0) return (true, 0);
uint256 c = a * b;
if (c / a != b) return (false, 0);
return (true, c);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the division of two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
unchecked {
if (b == 0) return (false, 0);
return (true, a / b);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryMod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
unchecked {
if (b == 0) return (false, 0);
return (true, a % b);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Addition cannot overflow.
*/
function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a + b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow (when the result is negative).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Subtraction cannot overflow.
*/
function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a - b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `*` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Multiplication cannot overflow.
*/
function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a * b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a / b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo),
* reverting when dividing by zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert`
* opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an
* invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a % b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on
* overflow (when the result is negative).
*
* CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error
* message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {trySub}.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Subtraction cannot overflow.
*/
function sub(
uint256 a,
uint256 b,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (uint256) {
unchecked {
require(b <= a, errorMessage);
return a - b;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on
* division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a
* `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity
* uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function div(
uint256 a,
uint256 b,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (uint256) {
unchecked {
require(b > 0, errorMessage);
return a / b;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo),
* reverting with custom message when dividing by zero.
*
* CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error
* message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryMod}.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert`
* opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an
* invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function mod(
uint256 a,
uint256 b,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (uint256) {
unchecked {
require(b > 0, errorMessage);
return a % b;
}
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Context.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
_checkOwner();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
*/
function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
// File: erc721a/contracts/IERC721A.sol
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721A.
*/
interface IERC721A {
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
*/
error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
/**
* Cannot mint to the zero address.
*/
error MintToZeroAddress();
/**
* The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
*/
error MintZeroQuantity();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token must be owned by `from`.
*/
error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
/**
* Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
* ERC721Receiver interface.
*/
error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
/**
* Cannot transfer to the zero address.
*/
error TransferToZeroAddress();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
*/
error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
/**
* The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
*/
error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
// =============================================================
// STRUCTS
// =============================================================
struct TokenOwnership {
// The address of the owner.
address addr;
// Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 startTimestamp;
// Whether the token has been burned.
bool burned;
// Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
uint24 extraData;
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTERS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
* (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
* checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
* to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
* this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
* whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
// =============================================================
// IERC2309
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
* (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
*
* See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
*/
event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
}
// File: erc721a/contracts/ERC721A.sol
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
*/
interface ERC721A__IERC721Receiver {
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
/**
* @title ERC721A
*
* @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
* Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
* Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
*
* Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
* starting from `_startTokenId()`.
*
* Assumptions:
*
* - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
* - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
*/
contract ERC721A is IERC721A {
// Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
struct TokenApprovalRef {
address value;
}
// =============================================================
// CONSTANTS
// =============================================================
// Mask of an entry in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
// The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
// The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
// The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
// Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
// The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
// The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
// The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
// The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
// The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
// Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
// The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
// The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
// This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
// For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
// is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
// The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
// `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
// =============================================================
// STORAGE
// =============================================================
// The next token ID to be minted.
uint256 private _currentIndex;
// The number of tokens burned.
uint256 private _burnCounter;
// Token name
string private _name;
// Token symbol
string private _symbol;
// Mapping from token ID to ownership details
// An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
// See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..159] `addr`
// - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
// - [224] `burned`
// - [225] `nextInitialized`
// - [232..255] `extraData`
mapping(uint256 => uint256) private _packedOwnerships;
// Mapping owner address to address data.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..63] `balance`
// - [64..127] `numberMinted`
// - [128..191] `numberBurned`
// - [192..255] `aux`
mapping(address => uint256) private _packedAddressData;
// Mapping from token ID to approved address.
mapping(uint256 => TokenApprovalRef) private _tokenApprovals;
// Mapping from owner to operator approvals
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
// =============================================================
// CONSTRUCTOR
// =============================================================
constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
_name = name_;
_symbol = symbol_;
_currentIndex = _startTokenId();
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the starting token ID.
* To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
*/
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
*/
function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return _currentIndex;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
// more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
*/
function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
// and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
*/
function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return _burnCounter;
}
// =============================================================
// ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
return _packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
*/
function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
*/
function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
*/
function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
return uint64(_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
}
/**
* Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
* If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
*/
function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = _packedAddressData[owner];
uint256 auxCasted;
// Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
auxCasted := aux
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
_packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
}
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
// The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
// of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
// See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
// (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
return
interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
}
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _name;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _symbol;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : '';
}
/**
* @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
* token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
* by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return '';
}
// =============================================================
// OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
}
/**
* @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
* It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
*/
function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
*/
function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnerships[index]);
}
/**
* @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
*/
function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
if (_packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
_packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
}
}
/**
* Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
*/
function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256) {
uint256 curr = tokenId;
unchecked {
if (_startTokenId() <= curr)
if (curr < _currentIndex) {
uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[curr];
// If not burned.
if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) {
// Invariant:
// There will always be an initialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// before an unintialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// Hence, `curr` will not underflow.
//
// We can directly compare the packed value.
// If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
while (packed == 0) {
packed = _packedOwnerships[--curr];
}
return packed;
}
}
}
revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
*/
function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
}
/**
* @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
*/
function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
*/
function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
// For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
assembly {
// `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
}
}
// =============================================================
// APPROVAL OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
return _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
}
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
_operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
}
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
*
* Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
*/
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return
_startTokenId() <= tokenId &&
tokenId < _currentIndex && // If within bounds,
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned.
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
*/
function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
address approvedAddress,
address owner,
address msgSender
) private pure returns (bool result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
*/
function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId)
private
view
returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress)
{
TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
// The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
assembly {
approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
}
}
// =============================================================
// TRANSFER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
--_packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
++_packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
// Updates:
// - `address` to the next owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
}
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public payable virtual override {
transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
if (to.code.length != 0)
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called before burning one token.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* have been transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called after one token has been burned.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _afterTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
*
* `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
* `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
* `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
* `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
*
* Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
*/
function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
try ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (
bytes4 retval
) {
return retval == ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
// =============================================================
// MINT OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
// `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
_packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
_packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
uint256 toMasked;
uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
// Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings.
// The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling.
// The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been
// delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes.
assembly {
// Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Emit the `Transfer` event.
log4(
0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
0, // End of data (0, since no data).
_TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
0, // `address(0)`.
toMasked, // `to`.
startTokenId // `tokenId`.
)
// The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
// that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
// The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance.
for {
let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1)
} iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) {
tokenId := add(tokenId, 1)
} {
// Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above.
log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId)
}
}
if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress();
_currentIndex = end;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
*
* It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
* instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
*
* Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
* non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
* For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
* {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
*/
function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
_packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
_packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
_currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* See {_mint}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data
) internal virtual {
_mint(to, quantity);
unchecked {
if (to.code.length != 0) {
uint256 end = _currentIndex;
uint256 index = end - quantity;
do {
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
} while (index < end);
// Reentrancy protection.
if (_currentIndex != end) revert();
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
*/
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
_safeMint(to, quantity, '');
}
// =============================================================
// BURN OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
* The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
if (approvalCheck) {
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance -= 1`.
// - `numberBurned += 1`.
//
// We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
// This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
_packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
// Updates:
// - `address` to the last owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
// - `burned` to `true`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
from,
(_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
unchecked {
_burnCounter++;
}
}
// =============================================================
// EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
*/
function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[index];
if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
uint256 extraDataCasted;
// Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
extraDataCasted := extraData
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
_packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
}
/**
* @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
* Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
*
* `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _extraData(
address from,
address to,
uint24 previousExtraData
) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
/**
* @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
* The returned result is shifted into position.
*/
function _nextExtraData(
address from,
address to,
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked
) private view returns (uint256) {
uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
}
// =============================================================
// OTHER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
*
* If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
*/
function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
/**
* @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
*/
function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
assembly {
// The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
// we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
// We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
// and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
// Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
mstore(0x40, m)
// Assign the `str` to the end.
str := sub(m, 0x20)
// Zeroize the slot after the string.
mstore(str, 0)
// Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
let end := str
// We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
// The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
// prettier-ignore
for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
str := sub(str, 1)
// Write the character to the pointer.
// The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
// Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
temp := div(temp, 10)
// prettier-ignore
if iszero(temp) { break }
}
let length := sub(end, str)
// Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
str := sub(str, 0x20)
// Store the length.
mstore(str, length)
}
}
}
// File: DegenWarriors.sol
// Degen Warriors NFT
pragma solidity ^0.8.17;
contract DegenWarriors is ERC721A, Ownable {
using SafeMath for uint256;
using Strings for uint256;
uint256 public constant MAX_TOKENS = 1366;
uint256 public price = 0.018 ether;
uint256 public presalePrice = 0.009 ether;
uint256 public maxPerALWallet = 2;
uint256 public maxPerWallet = 3;
// update this to owner address
address public constant w1 = 0x502614827D18C7fCeADCb2B349D3faf44393431f;
bool public publicSaleStarted = false;
bool public presaleStarted = false;
mapping(address => uint256) private _walletMints;
mapping(address => uint256) private _ALWalletMints;
bool public revealed = false; // by default collection is unrevealed
string public unRevealedURL = "https://ipfs.io/ipfs/QmYiRCPTf37YsufeG73L9YJKKapLCqgjz459ip8KduxQWw/hidden.json";
string public baseURI = "";
string public extensionURL = ".json";
bytes32 public merkleRoot = 0x11dc6bf27563bf6b68de1eff55f7b41ffe92ef586e3e84c5e503ce5bc142bd32;
constructor() ERC721A("Degen Warriors", "DGW") {}
function togglePresaleStarted() external onlyOwner {
presaleStarted = !presaleStarted;
}
function togglePublicSaleStarted() external onlyOwner {
publicSaleStarted = !publicSaleStarted;
}
function toggleRevealed() external onlyOwner {
revealed = !revealed;
}
function setPublicPrice(uint256 _newpublicPrice) external onlyOwner {
price = _newpublicPrice;
}
function setAllowListPrice(uint256 _newallowListprice) external onlyOwner {
presalePrice = _newallowListprice;
}
function setMaxPerWallet(uint256 _newMaxPerWallet) external onlyOwner {
maxPerWallet = _newMaxPerWallet;
}
function setMaxPerALWallet(uint256 _newMaxPerALWallet) external onlyOwner {
maxPerALWallet = _newMaxPerALWallet;
}
function setBaseURI(string memory _newBaseURI) external onlyOwner {
baseURI = _newBaseURI;
}
function setMerkleRoot(bytes32 _merkleRoot) external onlyOwner {
merkleRoot = _merkleRoot;
}
function setUnrevealURL(string memory _notRevealuri) public onlyOwner {
unRevealedURL = _notRevealuri;
}
function _baseURI() internal view override returns (string memory) {
return baseURI;
}
function _startTokenId() internal pure override returns (uint256) {
return 1;
}
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId)
public
view
virtual
override
returns (string memory)
{
require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721Metadata: Nonexistent token");
if (revealed == false) {
return unRevealedURL;
} else {
string memory currentBaseURI = _baseURI();
return
bytes(currentBaseURI).length > 0
? string(
abi.encodePacked(
currentBaseURI,
tokenId.toString(),
extensionURL
)
)
: "";
}
}
function mintAllowlist(uint256 tokens, bytes32[] calldata merkleProof)
external
payable
{
require(presaleStarted, "Sale has not started");
require(
MerkleProof.verify(
merkleProof,
merkleRoot,
keccak256(abi.encodePacked(msg.sender))
),
"Not on the allowlist"
);
require(
totalSupply() + tokens <= MAX_TOKENS,
"Minting would exceed max supply"
);
require(tokens > 0, "Must mint at least one Degen Warriors");
require(
_ALWalletMints[_msgSender()] + tokens <= maxPerALWallet,
"AL limit for this wallet reached"
);
require(presalePrice * tokens <= msg.value, "Not enough ETH");
_ALWalletMints[_msgSender()] += tokens;
_safeMint(_msgSender(), tokens);
}
function mint(uint256 tokens) external payable {
require(publicSaleStarted, "Sale has not started");
require(
totalSupply() + tokens <= MAX_TOKENS,
"Minting would exceed max supply"
);
require(tokens > 0, "Must mint at least one Degen Warriors");
require(
_walletMints[_msgSender()] + tokens <= maxPerWallet,
"Limit for this wallet reached"
);
require(price * tokens <= msg.value, "Not enough ETH");
_walletMints[_msgSender()] += tokens;
_safeMint(_msgSender(), tokens);
}
function withdrawAll() public onlyOwner {
uint256 balance = address(this).balance;
require(balance > 0, "Insufficent balance");
_withdraw(w1, ((balance * 100) / 100));
}
function _withdraw(address _address, uint256 _amount) private {
(bool success, ) = _address.call{value: _amount}("");
require(success, "Failed to withdraw Ether");
}
}File 5 of 10: UghaBugha
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol';
import 'erc721a/contracts/ERC721A.sol';
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Strings.sol";
contract UghaBugha is ERC721A, Ownable {
\tuint public constant MINT_PRICE = 0.0099 ether;
uint public publicSupply = 3800;
uint public wlSupply = 1200;
uint public maxSupply = publicSupply + wlSupply;
\tbool public isPublicSale = false;
\tbool public isWhitelistSale = false;
bool public isMetadataFinal;
string private _baseURL;
bytes32 public merkleRoot;
\tmapping(address => uint) private _publicWalletMintedCount;
\tmapping(address => uint) private _wlWalletMintedCount;
\tconstructor() ERC721A('UghaBugha', 'UB') {}
/* Owner functions */
\tfunction withdraw() external onlyOwner { // withdraws all ether balance to owner
\t\tuint balance = address(this).balance;
\t\trequire(balance > 0, 'No balance');
payable(owner()).transfer(balance);
\t}
\tfunction allCaptured(string memory url) external onlyOwner { // sets the baseURI (input metadata CID in ipfs://{cid}/ format)
require(!isMetadataFinal, "Metadata is finalized");
\t\t_baseURL = url;
\t}
\tfunction setUghalist(bool value) external onlyOwner { // activates/deactivates the Ughalist mint (1000 supply)
\t\tisWhitelistSale = value;
\t}
function setBugha(bool value) external onlyOwner { // activates/deactivates the Public mint (4000 supply)
\t\tisPublicSale = value;
\t}
function airdrop(address to, uint count) external onlyOwner { // airdrops token or tokens to address (address as argument)
require(
_totalMinted() + count <= maxSupply,
'Ugha Bugha: Exceeds max supply'
);
_safeMint(to, count);
}
function changeUghalistSupply(uint newMaxSupply) external onlyOwner { // changes the Ughalist supply
\t\twlSupply = newMaxSupply;
\t}
function changeBughaSupply(uint newMaxSupply) external onlyOwner { // changes the public supply
\t\tpublicSupply = newMaxSupply;
\t}
\tfunction setMerkleRoot(bytes32 _merkleRoot) external onlyOwner{ // sets the Merkle root (used for proof of Ughalist)
merkleRoot = _merkleRoot;
}
function burn(uint256 tokenId) public onlyOwner { // burns a token
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/* Public functions */
\tfunction _baseURI() internal view override returns (string memory) { // returns the baseURI (metadata CID)
\t\treturn _baseURL;
\t}
function addressMintedCount(address owner) external view returns (uint) { // returns the number of tokens minted for a user
return (_wlWalletMintedCount[owner] + _publicWalletMintedCount[owner]);
}
\tfunction tokenURI(uint tokenId) public view override returns (string memory) { // returns the tokenURI (in ipfs://{cid}/{tokenId}.json format)
require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721Metadata: URI query for nonexistent token");
return bytes(_baseURI()).length > 0
? string(abi.encodePacked(_baseURI(), Strings.toString(tokenId), ".json"))
: '';
\t}
\tfunction ughalistBirth(uint256 quantity, bytes32[] memory _merkleProof) external payable { // mints Ughalist tokens
require(isWhitelistSale, "WL sale is not open");
require(quantity > 0, "Quantity of tokens must be bigger than 0");
require(quantity < 3, "Quantity of tokens must be 1 or 2");
require(totalSupply() + quantity <= maxSupply, "Quantity exceeds max Ughalist supply of tokens");
require(_wlWalletMintedCount[msg.sender] == 0, "You have already minted.");
require(msg.value >= quantity * MINT_PRICE, "Insufficient ether value");
bytes32 leaf = keccak256(abi.encodePacked(msg.sender));
require(MerkleProof.verify(_merkleProof, merkleRoot, leaf), "Incorrect proof");
_wlWalletMintedCount[msg.sender] += quantity;
_safeMint(msg.sender, quantity);
}
\tfunction bughaBirth(uint256 quantity) external payable { // mints public tokens
require(isPublicSale, "Public sale is not open");
require(quantity > 0, "Quantity of tokens must be bigger than 0");
require(quantity < 3, "Quantity of tokens must be 1 or 2");
require(totalSupply() + quantity <= publicSupply, "Quantity exceeds max public supply of tokens");
require(_publicWalletMintedCount[msg.sender] == 0, "You have already minted.");
require(msg.value >= quantity * MINT_PRICE, "Insufficient ether value");
_publicWalletMintedCount[msg.sender] += quantity;
_safeMint(msg.sender, quantity);
}
}// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
_checkOwner();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
*/
function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.0
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import './IERC721A.sol';
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
*/
interface ERC721A__IERC721Receiver {
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
/**
* @title ERC721A
*
* @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
* Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
* Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
*
* Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
* starting from `_startTokenId()`.
*
* Assumptions:
*
* - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
* - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
*/
contract ERC721A is IERC721A {
// Reference type for token approval.
struct TokenApprovalRef {
address value;
}
// =============================================================
// CONSTANTS
// =============================================================
// Mask of an entry in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
// The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
// The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
// The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
// Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
// The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
// The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
// The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
// The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
// The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
// Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
// The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
// The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
// This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
// For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
// is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
// The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
// `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
// =============================================================
// STORAGE
// =============================================================
// The next token ID to be minted.
uint256 private _currentIndex;
// The number of tokens burned.
uint256 private _burnCounter;
// Token name
string private _name;
// Token symbol
string private _symbol;
// Mapping from token ID to ownership details
// An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
// See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..159] `addr`
// - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
// - [224] `burned`
// - [225] `nextInitialized`
// - [232..255] `extraData`
mapping(uint256 => uint256) private _packedOwnerships;
// Mapping owner address to address data.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..63] `balance`
// - [64..127] `numberMinted`
// - [128..191] `numberBurned`
// - [192..255] `aux`
mapping(address => uint256) private _packedAddressData;
// Mapping from token ID to approved address.
mapping(uint256 => TokenApprovalRef) private _tokenApprovals;
// Mapping from owner to operator approvals
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
// =============================================================
// CONSTRUCTOR
// =============================================================
constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
_name = name_;
_symbol = symbol_;
_currentIndex = _startTokenId();
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the starting token ID.
* To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
*/
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
*/
function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return _currentIndex;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
// more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
*/
function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
// and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
*/
function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return _burnCounter;
}
// =============================================================
// ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
return _packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
*/
function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
*/
function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
*/
function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
return uint64(_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
}
/**
* Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
* If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
*/
function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = _packedAddressData[owner];
uint256 auxCasted;
// Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
auxCasted := aux
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
_packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
}
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
// The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
// of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
// See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
// (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
return
interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
}
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _name;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _symbol;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : '';
}
/**
* @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
* token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
* by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return '';
}
// =============================================================
// OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
}
/**
* @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
* It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
*/
function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
*/
function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnerships[index]);
}
/**
* @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
*/
function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
if (_packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
_packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
}
}
/**
* Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
*/
function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256) {
uint256 curr = tokenId;
unchecked {
if (_startTokenId() <= curr)
if (curr < _currentIndex) {
uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[curr];
// If not burned.
if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) {
// Invariant:
// There will always be an initialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// before an unintialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// Hence, `curr` will not underflow.
//
// We can directly compare the packed value.
// If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
while (packed == 0) {
packed = _packedOwnerships[--curr];
}
return packed;
}
}
}
revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
*/
function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
}
/**
* @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
*/
function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
*/
function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
// For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
assembly {
// `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
}
}
// =============================================================
// APPROVAL OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public virtual override {
address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
return _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
}
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
if (operator == _msgSenderERC721A()) revert ApproveToCaller();
_operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
}
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
*
* Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
*/
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return
_startTokenId() <= tokenId &&
tokenId < _currentIndex && // If within bounds,
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned.
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
*/
function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
address approvedAddress,
address owner,
address msgSender
) private pure returns (bool result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
*/
function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId)
private
view
returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress)
{
TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
// The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
assembly {
approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
}
}
// =============================================================
// TRANSFER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public virtual override {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
--_packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
++_packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
// Updates:
// - `address` to the next owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
}
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public virtual override {
transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
if (to.code.length != 0)
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called before burning one token.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* have been transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called after one token has been burned.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _afterTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
*
* `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
* `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
* `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
* `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
*
* Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
*/
function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
try ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (
bytes4 retval
) {
return retval == ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
// =============================================================
// MINT OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
// `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
_packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
_packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
uint256 toMasked;
uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
// Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings.
assembly {
// Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Emit the `Transfer` event.
log4(
0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
0, // End of data (0, since no data).
_TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
0, // `address(0)`.
toMasked, // `to`.
startTokenId // `tokenId`.
)
for {
let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1)
} iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) {
tokenId := add(tokenId, 1)
} {
// Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above.
log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId)
}
}
if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress();
_currentIndex = end;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
*
* It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
* instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
*
* Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
* non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
* For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
* {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
*/
function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
_packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
_packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
_currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* See {_mint}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data
) internal virtual {
_mint(to, quantity);
unchecked {
if (to.code.length != 0) {
uint256 end = _currentIndex;
uint256 index = end - quantity;
do {
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
} while (index < end);
// Reentrancy protection.
if (_currentIndex != end) revert();
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
*/
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
_safeMint(to, quantity, '');
}
// =============================================================
// BURN OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
* The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
if (approvalCheck) {
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance -= 1`.
// - `numberBurned += 1`.
//
// We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
// This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
_packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
// Updates:
// - `address` to the last owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
// - `burned` to `true`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
_packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
from,
(_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
unchecked {
_burnCounter++;
}
}
// =============================================================
// EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
*/
function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[index];
if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
uint256 extraDataCasted;
// Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
extraDataCasted := extraData
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
_packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
}
/**
* @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
* Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
*
* `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _extraData(
address from,
address to,
uint24 previousExtraData
) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
/**
* @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
* The returned result is shifted into position.
*/
function _nextExtraData(
address from,
address to,
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked
) private view returns (uint256) {
uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
}
// =============================================================
// OTHER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
*
* If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
*/
function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
/**
* @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
*/
function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory ptr) {
assembly {
// The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit),
// but we allocate 128 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aliged.
// We will need 1 32-byte word to store the length,
// and 3 32-byte words to store a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 32 + 3 * 32 = 128.
ptr := add(mload(0x40), 128)
// Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
mstore(0x40, ptr)
// Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
let end := ptr
// We write the string from the rightmost digit to the leftmost digit.
// The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
// Costs a bit more than early returning for the zero case,
// but cheaper in terms of deployment and overall runtime costs.
for {
// Initialize and perform the first pass without check.
let temp := value
// Move the pointer 1 byte leftwards to point to an empty character slot.
ptr := sub(ptr, 1)
// Write the character to the pointer.
// The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
mstore8(ptr, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
temp := div(temp, 10)
} temp {
// Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
temp := div(temp, 10)
} {
// Body of the for loop.
ptr := sub(ptr, 1)
mstore8(ptr, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
}
let length := sub(end, ptr)
// Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
ptr := sub(ptr, 32)
// Store the length.
mstore(ptr, length)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev These functions deal with verification of Merkle Tree proofs.
*
* The proofs can be generated using the JavaScript library
* https://github.com/miguelmota/merkletreejs[merkletreejs].
* Note: the hashing algorithm should be keccak256 and pair sorting should be enabled.
*
* See `test/utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.test.js` for some examples.
*
* WARNING: You should avoid using leaf values that are 64 bytes long prior to
* hashing, or use a hash function other than keccak256 for hashing leaves.
* This is because the concatenation of a sorted pair of internal nodes in
* the merkle tree could be reinterpreted as a leaf value.
*/
library MerkleProof {
/**
* @dev Returns true if a `leaf` can be proved to be a part of a Merkle tree
* defined by `root`. For this, a `proof` must be provided, containing
* sibling hashes on the branch from the leaf to the root of the tree. Each
* pair of leaves and each pair of pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*/
function verify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processProof(proof, leaf) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {verify}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function verifyCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processProofCalldata(proof, leaf) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the rebuilt hash obtained by traversing a Merkle tree up
* from `leaf` using `proof`. A `proof` is valid if and only if the rebuilt
* hash matches the root of the tree. When processing the proof, the pairs
* of leafs & pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*
* _Available since v4.4._
*/
function processProof(bytes32[] memory proof, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
computedHash = _hashPair(computedHash, proof[i]);
}
return computedHash;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {processProof}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processProofCalldata(bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
computedHash = _hashPair(computedHash, proof[i]);
}
return computedHash;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the `leaves` can be proved to be a part of a Merkle tree defined by
* `root`, according to `proof` and `proofFlags` as described in {processMultiProof}.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function multiProofVerify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bool[] memory proofFlags,
bytes32 root,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processMultiProof(proof, proofFlags, leaves) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {multiProofVerify}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function multiProofVerifyCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bool[] calldata proofFlags,
bytes32 root,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processMultiProofCalldata(proof, proofFlags, leaves) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the root of a tree reconstructed from `leaves` and the sibling nodes in `proof`,
* consuming from one or the other at each step according to the instructions given by
* `proofFlags`.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processMultiProof(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bool[] memory proofFlags,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bytes32 merkleRoot) {
// This function rebuild the root hash by traversing the tree up from the leaves. The root is rebuilt by
// consuming and producing values on a queue. The queue starts with the `leaves` array, then goes onto the
// `hashes` array. At the end of the process, the last hash in the `hashes` array should contain the root of
// the merkle tree.
uint256 leavesLen = leaves.length;
uint256 totalHashes = proofFlags.length;
// Check proof validity.
require(leavesLen + proof.length - 1 == totalHashes, "MerkleProof: invalid multiproof");
// The xxxPos values are "pointers" to the next value to consume in each array. All accesses are done using
// `xxx[xxxPos++]`, which return the current value and increment the pointer, thus mimicking a queue's "pop".
bytes32[] memory hashes = new bytes32[](totalHashes);
uint256 leafPos = 0;
uint256 hashPos = 0;
uint256 proofPos = 0;
// At each step, we compute the next hash using two values:
// - a value from the "main queue". If not all leaves have been consumed, we get the next leaf, otherwise we
// get the next hash.
// - depending on the flag, either another value for the "main queue" (merging branches) or an element from the
// `proof` array.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalHashes; i++) {
bytes32 a = leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++];
bytes32 b = proofFlags[i] ? leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++] : proof[proofPos++];
hashes[i] = _hashPair(a, b);
}
if (totalHashes > 0) {
return hashes[totalHashes - 1];
} else if (leavesLen > 0) {
return leaves[0];
} else {
return proof[0];
}
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {processMultiProof}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processMultiProofCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bool[] calldata proofFlags,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bytes32 merkleRoot) {
// This function rebuild the root hash by traversing the tree up from the leaves. The root is rebuilt by
// consuming and producing values on a queue. The queue starts with the `leaves` array, then goes onto the
// `hashes` array. At the end of the process, the last hash in the `hashes` array should contain the root of
// the merkle tree.
uint256 leavesLen = leaves.length;
uint256 totalHashes = proofFlags.length;
// Check proof validity.
require(leavesLen + proof.length - 1 == totalHashes, "MerkleProof: invalid multiproof");
// The xxxPos values are "pointers" to the next value to consume in each array. All accesses are done using
// `xxx[xxxPos++]`, which return the current value and increment the pointer, thus mimicking a queue's "pop".
bytes32[] memory hashes = new bytes32[](totalHashes);
uint256 leafPos = 0;
uint256 hashPos = 0;
uint256 proofPos = 0;
// At each step, we compute the next hash using two values:
// - a value from the "main queue". If not all leaves have been consumed, we get the next leaf, otherwise we
// get the next hash.
// - depending on the flag, either another value for the "main queue" (merging branches) or an element from the
// `proof` array.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalHashes; i++) {
bytes32 a = leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++];
bytes32 b = proofFlags[i] ? leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++] : proof[proofPos++];
hashes[i] = _hashPair(a, b);
}
if (totalHashes > 0) {
return hashes[totalHashes - 1];
} else if (leavesLen > 0) {
return leaves[0];
} else {
return proof[0];
}
}
function _hashPair(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32) {
return a < b ? _efficientHash(a, b) : _efficientHash(b, a);
}
function _efficientHash(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32 value) {
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
mstore(0x00, a)
mstore(0x20, b)
value := keccak256(0x00, 0x40)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Strings.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev String operations.
*/
library Strings {
bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
uint8 private constant _ADDRESS_LENGTH = 20;
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
*/
function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
// Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
// https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
if (value == 0) {
return "0";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 digits;
while (temp != 0) {
digits++;
temp /= 10;
}
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
while (value != 0) {
digits -= 1;
buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
value /= 10;
}
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
if (value == 0) {
return "0x00";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 length = 0;
while (temp != 0) {
length++;
temp >>= 8;
}
return toHexString(value, length);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
buffer[0] = "0";
buffer[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
value >>= 4;
}
require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts an `address` with fixed length of 20 bytes to its not checksummed ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(address addr) internal pure returns (string memory) {
return toHexString(uint256(uint160(addr)), _ADDRESS_LENGTH);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.0
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721A.
*/
interface IERC721A {
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller cannot approve to their own address.
*/
error ApproveToCaller();
/**
* Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
*/
error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
/**
* Cannot mint to the zero address.
*/
error MintToZeroAddress();
/**
* The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
*/
error MintZeroQuantity();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token must be owned by `from`.
*/
error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
/**
* Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
* ERC721Receiver interface.
*/
error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
/**
* Cannot transfer to the zero address.
*/
error TransferToZeroAddress();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
*/
error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
/**
* The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
*/
error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
// =============================================================
// STRUCTS
// =============================================================
struct TokenOwnership {
// The address of the owner.
address addr;
// Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 startTimestamp;
// Whether the token has been burned.
bool burned;
// Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
uint24 extraData;
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTERS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
* (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
* checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
* to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
* this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external;
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
* whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
// =============================================================
// IERC2309
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
* (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
*
* See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
*/
event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
}
File 6 of 10: GoblinWaifu
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
//Developer Info:
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Strings.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Strings.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev String operations.
*/
library Strings {
bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
*/
function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
// Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
// https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
if (value == 0) {
return "0";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 digits;
while (temp != 0) {
digits++;
temp /= 10;
}
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
while (value != 0) {
digits -= 1;
buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
value /= 10;
}
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
if (value == 0) {
return "0x00";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 length = 0;
while (temp != 0) {
length++;
temp >>= 8;
}
return toHexString(value, length);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
buffer[0] = "0";
buffer[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
value >>= 4;
}
require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
return string(buffer);
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Context.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (utils/Address.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
*
* Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
* like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
* constructor.
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
// for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
// of the constructor execution.
return account.code.length > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
* revert reason using the provided one.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function verifyCallResult(
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @title ERC721 token receiver interface
* @dev Interface for any contract that wants to support safeTransfers
* from ERC721 asset contracts.
*/
interface IERC721Receiver {
/**
* @dev Whenever an {IERC721} `tokenId` token is transferred to this contract via {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}
* by `operator` from `from`, this function is called.
*
* It must return its Solidity selector to confirm the token transfer.
* If any other value is returned or the interface is not implemented by the recipient, the transfer will be reverted.
*
* The selector can be obtained in Solidity with `IERC721.onERC721Received.selector`.
*/
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/IERC165.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
*
* Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
* queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
*
* For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
*/
interface IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/ERC165.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
*
* Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
* for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
*
* ```solidity
* function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
* return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
* }
* ```
*
* Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
*/
abstract contract ERC165 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC165).interfaceId;
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/IERC721.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract.
*/
interface IERC721 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients
* are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external;
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/extensions/IERC721Metadata.sol
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/extensions/IERC721Metadata.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @title ERC-721 Non-Fungible Token Standard, optional metadata extension
* @dev See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721
*/
interface IERC721Metadata is IERC721 {
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
}
// File: contracts/new.sol
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
error ApproveToCaller();
error ApprovalToCurrentOwner();
error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
error MintToZeroAddress();
error MintZeroQuantity();
error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
error TransferToZeroAddress();
error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* @dev Implementation of https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721[ERC721] Non-Fungible Token Standard, including
* the Metadata extension. Built to optimize for lower gas during batch mints.
*
* Assumes serials are sequentially minted starting at _startTokenId() (defaults to 0, e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3..).
*
* Assumes that an owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
*
* Assumes that the maximum token id cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
*/
contract ERC721A is Context, ERC165, IERC721, IERC721Metadata {
using Address for address;
using Strings for uint256;
// Compiler will pack this into a single 256bit word.
struct TokenOwnership {
// The address of the owner.
address addr;
// Keeps track of the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 startTimestamp;
// Whether the token has been burned.
bool burned;
}
// Compiler will pack this into a single 256bit word.
struct AddressData {
// Realistically, 2**64-1 is more than enough.
uint64 balance;
// Keeps track of mint count with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 numberMinted;
// Keeps track of burn count with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 numberBurned;
// For miscellaneous variable(s) pertaining to the address
// (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
// If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
uint64 aux;
}
// The tokenId of the next token to be minted.
uint256 internal _currentIndex;
// The number of tokens burned.
uint256 internal _burnCounter;
// Token name
string private _name;
// Token symbol
string private _symbol;
// Mapping from token ID to ownership details
// An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned. See _ownershipOf implementation for details.
mapping(uint256 => TokenOwnership) internal _ownerships;
// Mapping owner address to address data
mapping(address => AddressData) private _addressData;
// Mapping from token ID to approved address
mapping(uint256 => address) private _tokenApprovals;
// Mapping from owner to operator approvals
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
_name = name_;
_symbol = symbol_;
_currentIndex = _startTokenId();
}
/**
* To change the starting tokenId, please override this function.
*/
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return 1;
}
/**
* @dev Burned tokens are calculated here, use _totalMinted() if you want to count just minted tokens.
*/
function totalSupply() public view returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
// more than _currentIndex - _startTokenId() times
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
*/
function _totalMinted() internal view returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _currentIndex does not decrement,
// and it is initialized to _startTokenId()
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(ERC165, IERC165) returns (bool) {
return
interfaceId == type(IERC721).interfaceId ||
interfaceId == type(IERC721Metadata).interfaceId ||
super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-balanceOf}.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) public view override returns (uint256) {
if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
return uint256(_addressData[owner].balance);
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
*/
function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return uint256(_addressData[owner].numberMinted);
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
*/
function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return uint256(_addressData[owner].numberBurned);
}
/**
* Returns the auxillary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
*/
function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
return _addressData[owner].aux;
}
/**
* Sets the auxillary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
* If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
*/
function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal {
_addressData[owner].aux = aux;
}
/**
* Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
* It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around in the collection over time.
*/
function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
uint256 curr = tokenId;
unchecked {
if (_startTokenId() <= curr && curr < _currentIndex) {
TokenOwnership memory ownership = _ownerships[curr];
if (!ownership.burned) {
if (ownership.addr != address(0)) {
return ownership;
}
// Invariant:
// There will always be an ownership that has an address and is not burned
// before an ownership that does not have an address and is not burned.
// Hence, curr will not underflow.
while (true) {
curr--;
ownership = _ownerships[curr];
if (ownership.addr != address(0)) {
return ownership;
}
}
}
}
}
revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-ownerOf}.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view override returns (address) {
return _ownershipOf(tokenId).addr;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721Metadata-name}.
*/
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _name;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721Metadata-symbol}.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _symbol;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721Metadata-tokenURI}.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, tokenId.toString())) : '';
}
/**
* @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
* token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
* by default, can be overriden in child contracts.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return '';
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-approve}.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public override {
address owner = ERC721A.ownerOf(tokenId);
if (to == owner) revert ApprovalToCurrentOwner();
if (_msgSender() != owner && !isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSender())) {
revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_approve(to, tokenId, owner);
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-getApproved}.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view override returns (address) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
return _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
if (operator == _msgSender()) revert ApproveToCaller();
_operatorApprovals[_msgSender()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSender(), operator, approved);
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-isApprovedForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-transferFrom}.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public virtual override {
_transfer(from, to, tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public virtual override {
_transfer(from, to, tokenId);
if (to.isContract() && !_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
*
* Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Tokens start existing when they are minted (`_mint`),
*/
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view returns (bool) {
return _startTokenId() <= tokenId && tokenId < _currentIndex &&
!_ownerships[tokenId].burned;
}
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal {
_safeMint(to, quantity, '');
}
/**
* @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data
) internal {
_mint(to, quantity, _data, true);
}
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _mint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data,
bool safe
) internal {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// balance or numberMinted overflow if current value of either + quantity > 1.8e19 (2**64) - 1
// updatedIndex overflows if _currentIndex + quantity > 1.2e77 (2**256) - 1
unchecked {
_addressData[to].balance += uint64(quantity);
_addressData[to].numberMinted += uint64(quantity);
_ownerships[startTokenId].addr = to;
_ownerships[startTokenId].startTimestamp = uint64(block.timestamp);
uint256 updatedIndex = startTokenId;
uint256 end = updatedIndex + quantity;
if (safe && to.isContract()) {
do {
emit Transfer(address(0), to, updatedIndex);
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, updatedIndex++, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
} while (updatedIndex != end);
// Reentrancy protection
if (_currentIndex != startTokenId) revert();
} else {
do {
emit Transfer(address(0), to, updatedIndex++);
} while (updatedIndex != end);
}
_currentIndex = updatedIndex;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _transfer(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) private {
TokenOwnership memory prevOwnership = _ownershipOf(tokenId);
if (prevOwnership.addr != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
bool isApprovedOrOwner = (_msgSender() == from ||
isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSender()) ||
getApproved(tokenId) == _msgSender());
if (!isApprovedOrOwner) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner
_approve(address(0), tokenId, from);
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as tokenId would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
_addressData[from].balance -= 1;
_addressData[to].balance += 1;
TokenOwnership storage currSlot = _ownerships[tokenId];
currSlot.addr = to;
currSlot.startTimestamp = uint64(block.timestamp);
// If the ownership slot of tokenId+1 is not explicitly set, that means the transfer initiator owns it.
// Set the slot of tokenId+1 explicitly in storage to maintain correctness for ownerOf(tokenId+1) calls.
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
TokenOwnership storage nextSlot = _ownerships[nextTokenId];
if (nextSlot.addr == address(0)) {
// This will suffice for checking _exists(nextTokenId),
// as a burned slot cannot contain the zero address.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
nextSlot.addr = from;
nextSlot.startTimestamp = prevOwnership.startTimestamp;
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
}
/**
* @dev This is equivalent to _burn(tokenId, false)
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
* The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
TokenOwnership memory prevOwnership = _ownershipOf(tokenId);
address from = prevOwnership.addr;
if (approvalCheck) {
bool isApprovedOrOwner = (_msgSender() == from ||
isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSender()) ||
getApproved(tokenId) == _msgSender());
if (!isApprovedOrOwner) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner
_approve(address(0), tokenId, from);
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as tokenId would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
AddressData storage addressData = _addressData[from];
addressData.balance -= 1;
addressData.numberBurned += 1;
// Keep track of who burned the token, and the timestamp of burning.
TokenOwnership storage currSlot = _ownerships[tokenId];
currSlot.addr = from;
currSlot.startTimestamp = uint64(block.timestamp);
currSlot.burned = true;
// If the ownership slot of tokenId+1 is not explicitly set, that means the burn initiator owns it.
// Set the slot of tokenId+1 explicitly in storage to maintain correctness for ownerOf(tokenId+1) calls.
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
TokenOwnership storage nextSlot = _ownerships[nextTokenId];
if (nextSlot.addr == address(0)) {
// This will suffice for checking _exists(nextTokenId),
// as a burned slot cannot contain the zero address.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
nextSlot.addr = from;
nextSlot.startTimestamp = prevOwnership.startTimestamp;
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
unchecked {
_burnCounter++;
}
}
/**
* @dev Approve `to` to operate on `tokenId`
*
* Emits a {Approval} event.
*/
function _approve(
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
address owner
) private {
_tokenApprovals[tokenId] = to;
emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev Internal function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
*
* @param from address representing the previous owner of the given token ID
* @param to target address that will receive the tokens
* @param tokenId uint256 ID of the token to be transferred
* @param _data bytes optional data to send along with the call
* @return bool whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value
*/
function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
try IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSender(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (bytes4 retval) {
return retval == IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token ids are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called before burning one token.
*
* startTokenId - the first token id to be transferred
* quantity - the amount to be transferred
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token ids have been transferred. This includes
* minting.
* And also called after one token has been burned.
*
* startTokenId - the first token id to be transferred
* quantity - the amount to be transferred
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _afterTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
}
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(owner() == _msgSender() , "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
contract GoblinWaifu is ERC721A, Ownable {
using Strings for uint256;
string private uriPrefix= "ipfs://QmUMsCtPDXo3gudYdSLF16P5zgGXm6rhb5nQ8Qc2Fv56qz/";
string private uriSuffix = ".json";
uint256 public cost = 0.0069 ether;
uint16 public constant maxSupply = 4444;
uint8 public maxMintAmountPerTx = 3;
bool public paused = true;
uint16 public freelimit = 3000;
address public proxyRegistryAddress = 0xa5409ec958C83C3f309868babACA7c86DCB077c1;
mapping(address => bool) public projectProxy;
constructor() ERC721A("GoblinWaifu", "GobWaifu") {
}
function mint(uint16 _mintAmount) external payable {
uint16 totalSupply = uint16(totalSupply());
require(totalSupply + _mintAmount <= maxSupply, "Exceeds max supply.");
require(_mintAmount <= maxMintAmountPerTx, "Exceeds max per transaction.");
require(!paused, "The contract is paused!");
if(totalSupply >= freelimit )
{require(msg.value >= cost * _mintAmount, "Insufficient funds!");
}
_safeMint(msg.sender , _mintAmount);
delete totalSupply;
delete _mintAmount;
}
function Reserve(uint16 _mintAmount, address _receiver) external onlyOwner {
uint16 totalSupply = uint16(totalSupply());
require(totalSupply + _mintAmount <= maxSupply, "Exceeds max supply.");
_safeMint(_receiver , _mintAmount);
delete _mintAmount;
delete _receiver;
delete totalSupply;
}
function tokenURI(uint256 _tokenId)
public
view
virtual
override
returns (string memory)
{
require(
_exists(_tokenId),
"ERC721Metadata: URI query for nonexistent token"
);
string memory currentBaseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(currentBaseURI).length > 0
? string(abi.encodePacked(currentBaseURI, _tokenId.toString() ,uriSuffix))
: "";
}
function setUriPrefix(string memory _uriPrefix) external onlyOwner {
uriPrefix = _uriPrefix;
}
function setPaused() external onlyOwner {
paused = !paused;
}
function setFreeLimit(uint16 _limit) external onlyOwner{
freelimit = _limit;
}
function setCost(uint _cost) external onlyOwner{
cost = _cost;
}
function setMaxMintAmountPerTx(uint8 _maxtx) external onlyOwner{
maxMintAmountPerTx = _maxtx;
}
function withdraw() external onlyOwner {
uint _balance = address(this).balance;
payable(0x4Eb145Ecc68d8D59a34E875F1d3Ad1906D9DA8da).transfer(_balance * 46 / 100);
payable(0x8728ED69FBc3D6b50aa3FBAA8aDE26972D59e7e0).transfer(_balance * 27 / 100);
payable(0x8a17F650D8f7d2d945311d60a9864C44cEE58048).transfer(_balance * 27 / 100);
}
function _baseURI() internal view override returns (string memory) {
return uriPrefix;
}
function isApprovedForAll(address _owner, address operator) public view override returns (bool) {
OpenSeaProxyRegistry proxyRegistry = OpenSeaProxyRegistry(proxyRegistryAddress);
if (address(proxyRegistry.proxies(_owner)) == operator || projectProxy[operator]) return true;
return super.isApprovedForAll(_owner, operator);
}
function flipProxyState(address proxyAddress) public onlyOwner {
projectProxy[proxyAddress] = !projectProxy[proxyAddress];
}
function setProxyRegistryAddress(address _proxyRegistryAddress) external onlyOwner {
proxyRegistryAddress = _proxyRegistryAddress;
}
}
contract OwnableDelegateProxy { }
contract OpenSeaProxyRegistry {
mapping(address => OwnableDelegateProxy) public proxies;
}File 7 of 10: MrBlock
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.7;
import "erc721a/contracts/ERC721A.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol";
contract MrBlock is ERC721A, Ownable {
uint public constant MAX_PER_WALLET_FREE = 2;
uint public constant MAX_PER_TX = 10;
uint public MAX_SUPPLY = 8888;
uint public price = 0.004 ether;
string public baseURI = "ipfs://Qma7gXeqgKNuwK2qt9GT9CQYbnsgGvmK3hvWfCGht4ky3s/";
string public constant baseExtension = ".json";
bool public paused = false;
bool public _live = false;
constructor() ERC721A("MrBlock", "MRBLK") {}
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual override returns (uint256) {
return 1;
}
function goMint(uint256 _amount) external payable {
address _caller = _msgSender();
require(!paused, "Paused");
require(_live, "Not live!");
require(MAX_SUPPLY >= totalSupply() + _amount, "Exceeds max supply");
require(_amount > 0, "No 0 mints");
require(tx.origin == _caller, "No contracts");
require(MAX_PER_TX >= _amount , "Excess max per paid tx");
if(_numberMinted(msg.sender) >= MAX_PER_WALLET_FREE) {
require(msg.value >= _amount * price, "Invalid funds provided");
} else{
uint count = _numberMinted(msg.sender) + _amount;
if(count > MAX_PER_WALLET_FREE){
require(msg.value >= (count - MAX_PER_WALLET_FREE) * price , "Insufficient funds");
}
}
_safeMint(_caller, _amount);
}
function withdraw() external onlyOwner {
uint256 balance = address(this).balance;
(bool success, ) = _msgSender().call{value: balance}("");
require(success, "Failed to send");
}
function initialize() external onlyOwner {
_safeMint(_msgSender(), 1);
}
function pause(bool _state) external onlyOwner {
paused = _state;
}
function setBaseURI(string memory baseURI_) external onlyOwner {
baseURI = baseURI_;
}
function live(bool _state) external onlyOwner {
_live = _state;
}
function setCost(uint256 newPrice) external onlyOwner {
price = newPrice;
}
function tokenURI(uint256 _tokenId) public view override returns (string memory) {
require(_exists(_tokenId), "Token does not exist.");
return bytes(baseURI).length > 0 ? string(
abi.encodePacked(
baseURI,
Strings.toString(_tokenId),
baseExtension
)
) : "";
}
}// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v3.3.0
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import './IERC721A.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Context.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Strings.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/ERC165.sol';
/**
* @dev Implementation of https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721[ERC721] Non-Fungible Token Standard, including
* the Metadata extension. Built to optimize for lower gas during batch mints.
*
* Assumes serials are sequentially minted starting at _startTokenId() (defaults to 0, e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3..).
*
* Assumes that an owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
*
* Assumes that the maximum token id cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
*/
contract ERC721A is Context, ERC165, IERC721A {
using Address for address;
using Strings for uint256;
// The tokenId of the next token to be minted.
uint256 internal _currentIndex;
// The number of tokens burned.
uint256 internal _burnCounter;
// Token name
string private _name;
// Token symbol
string private _symbol;
// Mapping from token ID to ownership details
// An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned. See _ownershipOf implementation for details.
mapping(uint256 => TokenOwnership) internal _ownerships;
// Mapping owner address to address data
mapping(address => AddressData) private _addressData;
// Mapping from token ID to approved address
mapping(uint256 => address) private _tokenApprovals;
// Mapping from owner to operator approvals
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
_name = name_;
_symbol = symbol_;
_currentIndex = _startTokenId();
}
/**
* To change the starting tokenId, please override this function.
*/
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return 0;
}
/**
* @dev Burned tokens are calculated here, use _totalMinted() if you want to count just minted tokens.
*/
function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
// more than _currentIndex - _startTokenId() times
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
*/
function _totalMinted() internal view returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _currentIndex does not decrement,
// and it is initialized to _startTokenId()
unchecked {
return _currentIndex - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(ERC165, IERC165) returns (bool) {
return
interfaceId == type(IERC721).interfaceId ||
interfaceId == type(IERC721Metadata).interfaceId ||
super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-balanceOf}.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) public view override returns (uint256) {
if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
return uint256(_addressData[owner].balance);
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
*/
function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return uint256(_addressData[owner].numberMinted);
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
*/
function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return uint256(_addressData[owner].numberBurned);
}
/**
* Returns the auxillary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
*/
function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
return _addressData[owner].aux;
}
/**
* Sets the auxillary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
* If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
*/
function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal {
_addressData[owner].aux = aux;
}
/**
* Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
* It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around in the collection over time.
*/
function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
uint256 curr = tokenId;
unchecked {
if (_startTokenId() <= curr) if (curr < _currentIndex) {
TokenOwnership memory ownership = _ownerships[curr];
if (!ownership.burned) {
if (ownership.addr != address(0)) {
return ownership;
}
// Invariant:
// There will always be an ownership that has an address and is not burned
// before an ownership that does not have an address and is not burned.
// Hence, curr will not underflow.
while (true) {
curr--;
ownership = _ownerships[curr];
if (ownership.addr != address(0)) {
return ownership;
}
}
}
}
}
revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-ownerOf}.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view override returns (address) {
return _ownershipOf(tokenId).addr;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721Metadata-name}.
*/
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _name;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721Metadata-symbol}.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _symbol;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721Metadata-tokenURI}.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, tokenId.toString())) : '';
}
/**
* @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
* token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
* by default, can be overriden in child contracts.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return '';
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-approve}.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public override {
address owner = ERC721A.ownerOf(tokenId);
if (to == owner) revert ApprovalToCurrentOwner();
if (_msgSender() != owner) if(!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSender())) {
revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_approve(to, tokenId, owner);
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-getApproved}.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view override returns (address) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
return _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
if (operator == _msgSender()) revert ApproveToCaller();
_operatorApprovals[_msgSender()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSender(), operator, approved);
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-isApprovedForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-transferFrom}.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public virtual override {
_transfer(from, to, tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public virtual override {
_transfer(from, to, tokenId);
if (to.isContract()) if(!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
*
* Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Tokens start existing when they are minted (`_mint`),
*/
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view returns (bool) {
return _startTokenId() <= tokenId && tokenId < _currentIndex && !_ownerships[tokenId].burned;
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
*/
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal {
_safeMint(to, quantity, '');
}
/**
* @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data
) internal {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// balance or numberMinted overflow if current value of either + quantity > 1.8e19 (2**64) - 1
// updatedIndex overflows if _currentIndex + quantity > 1.2e77 (2**256) - 1
unchecked {
_addressData[to].balance += uint64(quantity);
_addressData[to].numberMinted += uint64(quantity);
_ownerships[startTokenId].addr = to;
_ownerships[startTokenId].startTimestamp = uint64(block.timestamp);
uint256 updatedIndex = startTokenId;
uint256 end = updatedIndex + quantity;
if (to.isContract()) {
do {
emit Transfer(address(0), to, updatedIndex);
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, updatedIndex++, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
} while (updatedIndex < end);
// Reentrancy protection
if (_currentIndex != startTokenId) revert();
} else {
do {
emit Transfer(address(0), to, updatedIndex++);
} while (updatedIndex < end);
}
_currentIndex = updatedIndex;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal {
uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// balance or numberMinted overflow if current value of either + quantity > 1.8e19 (2**64) - 1
// updatedIndex overflows if _currentIndex + quantity > 1.2e77 (2**256) - 1
unchecked {
_addressData[to].balance += uint64(quantity);
_addressData[to].numberMinted += uint64(quantity);
_ownerships[startTokenId].addr = to;
_ownerships[startTokenId].startTimestamp = uint64(block.timestamp);
uint256 updatedIndex = startTokenId;
uint256 end = updatedIndex + quantity;
do {
emit Transfer(address(0), to, updatedIndex++);
} while (updatedIndex < end);
_currentIndex = updatedIndex;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _transfer(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) private {
TokenOwnership memory prevOwnership = _ownershipOf(tokenId);
if (prevOwnership.addr != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
bool isApprovedOrOwner = (_msgSender() == from ||
isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSender()) ||
getApproved(tokenId) == _msgSender());
if (!isApprovedOrOwner) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner
_approve(address(0), tokenId, from);
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as tokenId would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
_addressData[from].balance -= 1;
_addressData[to].balance += 1;
TokenOwnership storage currSlot = _ownerships[tokenId];
currSlot.addr = to;
currSlot.startTimestamp = uint64(block.timestamp);
// If the ownership slot of tokenId+1 is not explicitly set, that means the transfer initiator owns it.
// Set the slot of tokenId+1 explicitly in storage to maintain correctness for ownerOf(tokenId+1) calls.
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
TokenOwnership storage nextSlot = _ownerships[nextTokenId];
if (nextSlot.addr == address(0)) {
// This will suffice for checking _exists(nextTokenId),
// as a burned slot cannot contain the zero address.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
nextSlot.addr = from;
nextSlot.startTimestamp = prevOwnership.startTimestamp;
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
* The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
TokenOwnership memory prevOwnership = _ownershipOf(tokenId);
address from = prevOwnership.addr;
if (approvalCheck) {
bool isApprovedOrOwner = (_msgSender() == from ||
isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSender()) ||
getApproved(tokenId) == _msgSender());
if (!isApprovedOrOwner) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner
_approve(address(0), tokenId, from);
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as tokenId would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
AddressData storage addressData = _addressData[from];
addressData.balance -= 1;
addressData.numberBurned += 1;
// Keep track of who burned the token, and the timestamp of burning.
TokenOwnership storage currSlot = _ownerships[tokenId];
currSlot.addr = from;
currSlot.startTimestamp = uint64(block.timestamp);
currSlot.burned = true;
// If the ownership slot of tokenId+1 is not explicitly set, that means the burn initiator owns it.
// Set the slot of tokenId+1 explicitly in storage to maintain correctness for ownerOf(tokenId+1) calls.
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
TokenOwnership storage nextSlot = _ownerships[nextTokenId];
if (nextSlot.addr == address(0)) {
// This will suffice for checking _exists(nextTokenId),
// as a burned slot cannot contain the zero address.
if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
nextSlot.addr = from;
nextSlot.startTimestamp = prevOwnership.startTimestamp;
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
unchecked {
_burnCounter++;
}
}
/**
* @dev Approve `to` to operate on `tokenId`
*
* Emits a {Approval} event.
*/
function _approve(
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
address owner
) private {
_tokenApprovals[tokenId] = to;
emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev Internal function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
*
* @param from address representing the previous owner of the given token ID
* @param to target address that will receive the tokens
* @param tokenId uint256 ID of the token to be transferred
* @param _data bytes optional data to send along with the call
* @return bool whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value
*/
function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
try IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSender(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (bytes4 retval) {
return retval == IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token ids are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called before burning one token.
*
* startTokenId - the first token id to be transferred
* quantity - the amount to be transferred
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token ids have been transferred. This includes
* minting.
* And also called after one token has been burned.
*
* startTokenId - the first token id to be transferred
* quantity - the amount to be transferred
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _afterTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "./IERC165.sol";
/**
* @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
*
* Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
* for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
*
* ```solidity
* function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
* return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
* }
* ```
*
* Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
*/
abstract contract ERC165 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC165).interfaceId;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Strings.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev String operations.
*/
library Strings {
bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
*/
function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
// Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
// https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
if (value == 0) {
return "0";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 digits;
while (temp != 0) {
digits++;
temp /= 10;
}
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
while (value != 0) {
digits -= 1;
buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
value /= 10;
}
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
if (value == 0) {
return "0x00";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 length = 0;
while (temp != 0) {
length++;
temp >>= 8;
}
return toHexString(value, length);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
buffer[0] = "0";
buffer[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
value >>= 4;
}
require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
return string(buffer);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (utils/Address.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
*
* Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
* like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
* constructor.
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
// for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
// of the constructor execution.
return account.code.length > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
* revert reason using the provided one.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function verifyCallResult(
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @title ERC721 token receiver interface
* @dev Interface for any contract that wants to support safeTransfers
* from ERC721 asset contracts.
*/
interface IERC721Receiver {
/**
* @dev Whenever an {IERC721} `tokenId` token is transferred to this contract via {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}
* by `operator` from `from`, this function is called.
*
* It must return its Solidity selector to confirm the token transfer.
* If any other value is returned or the interface is not implemented by the recipient, the transfer will be reverted.
*
* The selector can be obtained in Solidity with `IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector`.
*/
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v3.3.0
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/extensions/IERC721Metadata.sol';
/**
* @dev Interface of an ERC721A compliant contract.
*/
interface IERC721A is IERC721, IERC721Metadata {
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller cannot approve to their own address.
*/
error ApproveToCaller();
/**
* The caller cannot approve to the current owner.
*/
error ApprovalToCurrentOwner();
/**
* Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
*/
error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
/**
* Cannot mint to the zero address.
*/
error MintToZeroAddress();
/**
* The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
*/
error MintZeroQuantity();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token must be owned by `from`.
*/
error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
/**
* Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the ERC721Receiver interface.
*/
error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
/**
* Cannot transfer to the zero address.
*/
error TransferToZeroAddress();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
// Compiler will pack this into a single 256bit word.
struct TokenOwnership {
// The address of the owner.
address addr;
// Keeps track of the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 startTimestamp;
// Whether the token has been burned.
bool burned;
}
// Compiler will pack this into a single 256bit word.
struct AddressData {
// Realistically, 2**64-1 is more than enough.
uint64 balance;
// Keeps track of mint count with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 numberMinted;
// Keeps track of burn count with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 numberBurned;
// For miscellaneous variable(s) pertaining to the address
// (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
// If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
uint64 aux;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of tokens stored by the contract.
*
* Burned tokens are calculated here, use `_totalMinted()` if you want to count just minted tokens.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/extensions/IERC721Metadata.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../IERC721.sol";
/**
* @title ERC-721 Non-Fungible Token Standard, optional metadata extension
* @dev See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721
*/
interface IERC721Metadata is IERC721 {
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC721/IERC721.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../../utils/introspection/IERC165.sol";
/**
* @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract.
*/
interface IERC721 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external;
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients
* are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
*
* Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
* queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
*
* For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
*/
interface IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
}
File 8 of 10: LFOX
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_setOwner(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_setOwner(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_setOwner(newOwner);
}
function _setOwner(address newOwner) private {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
library Strings {
bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
*/
function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
// Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
// https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
if (value == 0) {
return "0";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 digits;
while (temp != 0) {
digits++;
temp /= 10;
}
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
while (value != 0) {
digits -= 1;
buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
value /= 10;
}
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
if (value == 0) {
return "0x00";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 length = 0;
while (temp != 0) {
length++;
temp >>= 8;
}
return toHexString(value, length);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
buffer[0] = "0";
buffer[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
value >>= 4;
}
require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
return string(buffer);
}
}
abstract contract ReentrancyGuard {
// Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full
// word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the
// slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write
// back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and
// pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled.
// The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive,
// but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in
// amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total
// transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to
// increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect.
uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1;
uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2;
uint256 private _status;
constructor() {
_status = _NOT_ENTERED;
}
/**
* @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly.
* Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant`
* function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening
* by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and make it call a
* `private` function that does the actual work.
*/
modifier nonReentrant() {
// On the first call to nonReentrant, _notEntered will be true
require(_status != _ENTERED, "ReentrancyGuard: reentrant call");
// Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail
_status = _ENTERED;
_;
// By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see
// https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200)
_status = _NOT_ENTERED;
}
}
interface IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
}
interface IERC721 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients
* are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external;
}
interface IERC721Enumerable is IERC721 {
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of tokens stored by the contract.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns a token ID owned by `owner` at a given `index` of its token list.
* Use along with {balanceOf} to enumerate all of ``owner``'s tokens.
*/
function tokenOfOwnerByIndex(address owner, uint256 index) external view returns (uint256 tokenId);
/**
* @dev Returns a token ID at a given `index` of all the tokens stored by the contract.
* Use along with {totalSupply} to enumerate all tokens.
*/
function tokenByIndex(uint256 index) external view returns (uint256);
}
interface IERC721Receiver {
/**
* @dev Whenever an {IERC721} `tokenId` token is transferred to this contract via {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}
* by `operator` from `from`, this function is called.
*
* It must return its Solidity selector to confirm the token transfer.
* If any other value is returned or the interface is not implemented by the recipient, the transfer will be reverted.
*
* The selector can be obtained in Solidity with `IERC721.onERC721Received.selector`.
*/
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
interface IERC721Metadata is IERC721 {
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
}
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in
// construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the
// constructor execution.
uint256 size;
assembly {
size := extcodesize(account)
}
return size > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
* revert reason using the provided one.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function verifyCallResult(
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
abstract contract ERC165 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC165).interfaceId;
}
}
interface IERC2981Royalties {
function royaltyInfo(uint256 _tokenId, uint256 _value) external view returns (address _receiver, uint256 _royaltyAmount);
}
abstract contract ERC2981Base is ERC165, IERC2981Royalties {
struct RoyaltyInfo {
address recipient;
uint24 amount;
}
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool){
return interfaceId == type(IERC2981Royalties).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
}
abstract contract ERC2981Royalties is ERC2981Base {
RoyaltyInfo private _royalties;
function _setRoyalties(address recipient, uint256 value) internal {
require(value <= 10000, 'ERC2981Royalties: Too high');
_royalties = RoyaltyInfo(recipient, uint24(value));
}
function royaltyInfo(uint256, uint256 value) external view override returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount){
RoyaltyInfo memory royalties = _royalties;
receiver = royalties.recipient;
royaltyAmount = (value * royalties.amount) / 10000;
}
}
abstract contract ERC721P is Context, ERC165, IERC721, ERC2981Royalties, IERC721Metadata {
using Address for address;
string private _name;
string private _symbol;
address[] internal _owners;
mapping(uint256 => address) private _tokenApprovals;
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
_name = name_;
_symbol = symbol_;
}
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(ERC165, IERC165, ERC2981Base) returns (bool) {
return
interfaceId == type(IERC721).interfaceId ||
interfaceId == type(IERC721Metadata).interfaceId ||
interfaceId == type(IERC2981Royalties).interfaceId ||
super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
require(owner != address(0), "ERC721: balance query for the zero address");
uint count = 0;
uint length = _owners.length;
for( uint i = 0; i < length; ++i ){
if( owner == _owners[i] ){
++count;
}
}
delete length;
return count;
}
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
address owner = _owners[tokenId];
require(owner != address(0), "ERC721: owner query for nonexistent token");
return owner;
}
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _name;
}
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _symbol;
}
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public virtual override {
address owner = ERC721P.ownerOf(tokenId);
require(to != owner, "ERC721: approval to current owner");
require(
_msgSender() == owner || isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSender()),
"ERC721: approve caller is not owner nor approved for all"
);
_approve(to, tokenId);
}
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: approved query for nonexistent token");
return _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
}
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
require(operator != _msgSender(), "ERC721: approve to caller");
_operatorApprovals[_msgSender()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSender(), operator, approved);
}
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public virtual override {
//solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length
require(_isApprovedOrOwner(_msgSender(), tokenId), "ERC721: transfer caller is not owner nor approved");
_transfer(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, "");
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public virtual override {
require(_isApprovedOrOwner(_msgSender(), tokenId), "ERC721: transfer caller is not owner nor approved");
_safeTransfer(from, to, tokenId, _data);
}
function _safeTransfer(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) internal virtual {
_transfer(from, to, tokenId);
require(_checkOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data), "ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer");
}
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return tokenId < _owners.length && _owners[tokenId] != address(0);
}
function _isApprovedOrOwner(address spender, uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: operator query for nonexistent token");
address owner = ERC721P.ownerOf(tokenId);
return (spender == owner || getApproved(tokenId) == spender || isApprovedForAll(owner, spender));
}
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_safeMint(to, tokenId, "");
}
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) internal virtual {
_mint(to, tokenId);
require(
_checkOnERC721Received(address(0), to, tokenId, _data),
"ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer"
);
}
function _mint(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
require(to != address(0), "ERC721: mint to the zero address");
require(!_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: token already minted");
_beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), to, tokenId);
_owners.push(to);
emit Transfer(address(0), to, tokenId);
}
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
address owner = ERC721P.ownerOf(tokenId);
_beforeTokenTransfer(owner, address(0), tokenId);
// Clear approvals
_approve(address(0), tokenId);
_owners[tokenId] = address(0);
emit Transfer(owner, address(0), tokenId);
}
function _transfer(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) internal virtual {
require(ERC721P.ownerOf(tokenId) == from, "ERC721: transfer of token that is not own");
require(to != address(0), "ERC721: transfer to the zero address");
_beforeTokenTransfer(from, to, tokenId);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner
_approve(address(0), tokenId);
_owners[tokenId] = to;
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
}
function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_tokenApprovals[tokenId] = to;
emit Approval(ERC721P.ownerOf(tokenId), to, tokenId);
}
function _checkOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
if (to.isContract()) {
try IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSender(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (bytes4 retval) {
return retval == IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert("ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer");
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
} else {
return true;
}
}
function _beforeTokenTransfer(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) internal virtual {}
}
abstract contract ERC721Enum is ERC721P, IERC721Enumerable {
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(IERC165, ERC721P) returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC721Enumerable).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
function tokenOfOwnerByIndex(address owner, uint256 index) public view override returns (uint256 tokenId) {
require(index < ERC721P.balanceOf(owner), "ERC721Enum: owner ioob");
uint count;
for( uint i; i < _owners.length; ++i ){
if( owner == _owners[i] ){
if( count == index )
return i;
else
++count;
}
}
require(false, "ERC721Enum: owner ioob");
}
function tokensOfOwner(address owner) public view returns (uint256[] memory) {
require(0 < ERC721P.balanceOf(owner), "ERC721Enum: owner ioob");
uint256 tokenCount = balanceOf(owner);
uint256[] memory tokenIds = new uint256[](tokenCount);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokenCount; i++) {
tokenIds[i] = tokenOfOwnerByIndex(owner, i);
}
return tokenIds;
}
function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
return _owners.length;
}
function tokenByIndex(uint256 index) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
require(index < ERC721Enum.totalSupply(), "ERC721Enum: global ioob");
return index;
}
}
library MerkleProof {
/**
* @dev Returns true if a `leaf` can be proved to be a part of a Merkle tree
* defined by `root`. For this, a `proof` must be provided, containing
* sibling hashes on the branch from the leaf to the root of the tree. Each
* pair of leaves and each pair of pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*/
function verify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
bytes32 proofElement = proof[i];
if (computedHash <= proofElement) {
// Hash(current computed hash + current element of the proof)
computedHash = keccak256(abi.encodePacked(computedHash, proofElement));
} else {
// Hash(current element of the proof + current computed hash)
computedHash = keccak256(abi.encodePacked(proofElement, computedHash));
}
}
// Check if the computed hash (root) is equal to the provided root
return computedHash == root;
}
}
contract LFOX is ERC721Enum, Ownable, ReentrancyGuard{
using Strings for uint256;
uint256 public SALE_NFT = 9940;
uint256 public GIVEAWAY_NFT = 60;
uint256 public MAX_MINT_PRESALE = 20;
uint256 public MAX_MINT_SALE = 20;
uint256 public MAX_BY_MINT_IN_TRANSACTION_PRESALE = 20;
uint256 public MAX_BY_MINT_IN_TRANSACTION_SALE = 20;
uint256 public PRESALE_PRICE = 0.02 ether;
uint256 public SALE_PRICE = 0.04 ether;
uint256 public SALE_MINTED;
uint256 public GIVEAWAY_MINTED;
bool public presaleEnable = false;
bool public saleEnable = false;
address[] public addressList = [
0x29984e0e7EF7834b1ffD744e206d54609dd5A4fF,
0xfD4eB3Af772362743b3962c870Ea3bB71dd65fA7
];
uint[] public shareList = [70,30];
string private baseURI;
bytes32 public merkleRoot;
struct User {
uint256 presalemint;
uint256 salemint;
}
mapping (address => User) public users;
constructor() ERC721P('Lunatic Foxes', 'LFOX') {
}
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return baseURI;
}
function mintGiveawayNFT(address _to, uint256 _count) public onlyOwner{
uint256 totalSupply = totalSupply();
require(
GIVEAWAY_MINTED + _count <= GIVEAWAY_NFT,
"Max limit"
);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < _count; i++) {
_safeMint(_to, totalSupply + i);
GIVEAWAY_MINTED++;
}
}
function mintPreSaleNFT(uint256 _count, bytes32[] calldata merkleProof) public payable{
bytes32 node = keccak256(abi.encodePacked(msg.sender));
uint256 totalSupply = totalSupply();
require(
presaleEnable,
"Pre-sale is not enable"
);
require(
SALE_MINTED + _count <= SALE_NFT,
"Exceeds max limit"
);
require(
MerkleProof.verify(merkleProof, merkleRoot, node),
"MerkleDistributor: Invalid proof."
);
require(
users[msg.sender].presalemint + _count <= MAX_MINT_PRESALE,
"Exceeds max mint limit per wallet"
);
require(
_count <= MAX_BY_MINT_IN_TRANSACTION_PRESALE,
"Exceeds max mint limit per txn"
);
require(
msg.value >= PRESALE_PRICE * _count,
"Value below price"
);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < _count; i++) {
_safeMint(msg.sender, totalSupply + i);
SALE_MINTED++;
}
users[msg.sender].presalemint = users[msg.sender].presalemint + _count;
}
function mintSaleNFT(uint256 _count) public payable{
uint256 totalSupply = totalSupply();
require(
saleEnable,
"Sale is not enable"
);
require(
SALE_MINTED + _count <= SALE_NFT,
"Exceeds max limit"
);
require(
users[msg.sender].salemint + _count <= MAX_MINT_SALE,
"Exceeds max mint limit per wallet"
);
require(
_count <= MAX_BY_MINT_IN_TRANSACTION_SALE,
"Exceeds max mint limit per txn"
);
require(
msg.value >= SALE_PRICE * _count,
"Value below price"
);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < _count; i++) {
_safeMint(msg.sender, totalSupply + i);
SALE_MINTED++;
}
users[msg.sender].salemint = users[msg.sender].salemint + _count;
}
function tokenURI(uint256 _tokenId) external view virtual override returns (string memory) {
require(_exists(_tokenId), "ERC721Metadata: Nonexistent token");
string memory currentBaseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(currentBaseURI).length > 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(currentBaseURI, _tokenId.toString(), ".json")) : "";
}
function transferFrom(address _from, address _to, uint256 _tokenId) public override {
ERC721P.transferFrom(_from, _to, _tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(address _from, address _to, uint256 _tokenId, bytes memory _data) public override {
ERC721P.safeTransferFrom(_from, _to, _tokenId, _data);
}
function withdrawAll() public onlyOwner {
uint256 balance = address(this).balance;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < addressList.length; i++) {
payable(addressList[i]).transfer((balance * shareList[i]) / 100);
}
}
function setBaseURI(string memory newBaseURI) public onlyOwner {
baseURI = newBaseURI;
}
function updateSalePrice(uint256 newPrice) external onlyOwner {
SALE_PRICE = newPrice;
}
function updatePreSalePrice(uint256 newPrice) external onlyOwner {
PRESALE_PRICE = newPrice;
}
function setSaleStatus(bool status) public onlyOwner {
require(saleEnable != status, "Incorrect value");
saleEnable = status;
}
function setPreSaleStatus(bool status) public onlyOwner {
require(presaleEnable != status, "Incorrect value");
presaleEnable = status;
}
function updateSaleMintLimit(uint256 newLimit) external onlyOwner {
require(SALE_NFT >= newLimit, "Incorrect value");
MAX_MINT_SALE = newLimit;
}
function updatePreSaleMintLimit(uint256 newLimit) external onlyOwner {
require(SALE_NFT >= newLimit, "Incorrect value");
MAX_MINT_PRESALE = newLimit;
}
function updateSaleSupply(uint256 newSupply) external onlyOwner {
require(newSupply >= SALE_MINTED, "Incorrect value");
SALE_NFT = newSupply;
}
function updateGiveawaySupply(uint256 newSupply) external onlyOwner {
require(newSupply >= GIVEAWAY_MINTED, "Incorrect value");
GIVEAWAY_NFT = newSupply;
}
function updateMintLimitPerTransectionPreSale(uint256 newLimit) external onlyOwner {
require(SALE_NFT >= newLimit, "Incorrect value");
MAX_BY_MINT_IN_TRANSACTION_PRESALE = newLimit;
}
function updateMintLimitPerTransectionSale(uint256 newLimit) external onlyOwner {
require(SALE_NFT >= newLimit, "Incorrect value");
MAX_BY_MINT_IN_TRANSACTION_SALE = newLimit;
}
function updateMerkleRoot(bytes32 newRoot) external onlyOwner {
merkleRoot = newRoot;
}
function setRoyalties(address recipient, uint256 value) public onlyOwner{
_setRoyalties(recipient, value);
}
function updateAddressList(address ownerAddress, address partnerAddress) external onlyOwner {
require(ownerAddress != address(0), "address is the zero address");
require(partnerAddress != address(0), "address is the zero address");
addressList[0] = ownerAddress;
addressList[1] = partnerAddress;
}
function updateShareList(uint256 ownerShare, uint256 partnerShare) external onlyOwner {
require(ownerShare + partnerShare == 100, "share must be 100%");
shareList[0] = ownerShare;
shareList[1] = partnerShare;
}
}File 9 of 10: OperatorFilterRegistry
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
_checkOwner();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
*/
function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/structs/EnumerableSet.sol)
// This file was procedurally generated from scripts/generate/templates/EnumerableSet.js.
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Library for managing
* https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Set_(abstract_data_type)[sets] of primitive
* types.
*
* Sets have the following properties:
*
* - Elements are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time
* (O(1)).
* - Elements are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering.
*
* ```
* contract Example {
* // Add the library methods
* using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
*
* // Declare a set state variable
* EnumerableSet.AddressSet private mySet;
* }
* ```
*
* As of v3.3.0, sets of type `bytes32` (`Bytes32Set`), `address` (`AddressSet`)
* and `uint256` (`UintSet`) are supported.
*
* [WARNING]
* ====
* Trying to delete such a structure from storage will likely result in data corruption, rendering the structure
* unusable.
* See https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/pull/11843[ethereum/solidity#11843] for more info.
*
* In order to clean an EnumerableSet, you can either remove all elements one by one or create a fresh instance using an
* array of EnumerableSet.
* ====
*/
library EnumerableSet {
// To implement this library for multiple types with as little code
// repetition as possible, we write it in terms of a generic Set type with
// bytes32 values.
// The Set implementation uses private functions, and user-facing
// implementations (such as AddressSet) are just wrappers around the
// underlying Set.
// This means that we can only create new EnumerableSets for types that fit
// in bytes32.
struct Set {
// Storage of set values
bytes32[] _values;
// Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0
// means a value is not in the set.
mapping(bytes32 => uint256) _indexes;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function _add(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) {
if (!_contains(set, value)) {
set._values.push(value);
// The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes
// and use 0 as a sentinel value
set._indexes[value] = set._values.length;
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function _remove(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) {
// We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value];
if (valueIndex != 0) {
// Equivalent to contains(set, value)
// To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in
// the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop').
// This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}.
uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1;
uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1;
if (lastIndex != toDeleteIndex) {
bytes32 lastValue = set._values[lastIndex];
// Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is
set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastValue;
// Update the index for the moved value
set._indexes[lastValue] = valueIndex; // Replace lastValue's index to valueIndex
}
// Delete the slot where the moved value was stored
set._values.pop();
// Delete the index for the deleted slot
delete set._indexes[value];
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function _contains(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private view returns (bool) {
return set._indexes[value] != 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1).
*/
function _length(Set storage set) private view returns (uint256) {
return set._values.length;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function _at(Set storage set, uint256 index) private view returns (bytes32) {
return set._values[index];
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function _values(Set storage set) private view returns (bytes32[] memory) {
return set._values;
}
// Bytes32Set
struct Bytes32Set {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1).
*/
function length(Bytes32Set storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(Bytes32Set storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) {
return _at(set._inner, index);
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(Bytes32Set storage set) internal view returns (bytes32[] memory) {
bytes32[] memory store = _values(set._inner);
bytes32[] memory result;
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
result := store
}
return result;
}
// AddressSet
struct AddressSet {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1).
*/
function length(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) {
return address(uint160(uint256(_at(set._inner, index))));
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (address[] memory) {
bytes32[] memory store = _values(set._inner);
address[] memory result;
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
result := store
}
return result;
}
// UintSet
struct UintSet {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1).
*/
function length(UintSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(UintSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (uint256) {
return uint256(_at(set._inner, index));
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(UintSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256[] memory) {
bytes32[] memory store = _values(set._inner);
uint256[] memory result;
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
result := store
}
return result;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
import {EnumerableSet} from "openzeppelin-contracts/utils/structs/EnumerableSet.sol";
interface IOperatorFilterRegistry {
function isOperatorAllowed(address registrant, address operator) external returns (bool);
function register(address registrant) external;
function registerAndSubscribe(address registrant, address subscription) external;
function registerAndCopyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function updateOperator(address registrant, address operator, bool filtered) external;
function updateOperators(address registrant, address[] calldata operators, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHash(address registrant, bytes32 codehash, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHashes(address registrant, bytes32[] calldata codeHashes, bool filtered) external;
function subscribe(address registrant, address registrantToSubscribe) external;
function unsubscribe(address registrant, bool copyExistingEntries) external;
function subscriptionOf(address addr) external returns (address registrant);
function subscribers(address registrant) external returns (address[] memory);
function subscriberAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function copyEntriesOf(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function isOperatorFiltered(address registrant, address operator) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashOfFiltered(address registrant, address operatorWithCode) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashFiltered(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash) external returns (bool);
function filteredOperators(address addr) external returns (address[] memory);
function filteredCodeHashes(address addr) external returns (bytes32[] memory);
function filteredOperatorAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function filteredCodeHashAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (bytes32);
function isRegistered(address addr) external returns (bool);
function codeHashOf(address addr) external returns (bytes32);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
import {IOperatorFilterRegistry} from "./IOperatorFilterRegistry.sol";
import {Ownable} from "openzeppelin-contracts/access/Ownable.sol";
import {EnumerableSet} from "openzeppelin-contracts/utils/structs/EnumerableSet.sol";
import {OperatorFilterRegistryErrorsAndEvents} from "./OperatorFilterRegistryErrorsAndEvents.sol";
/**
* @title OperatorFilterRegistry
* @notice Borrows heavily from the QQL BlacklistOperatorFilter contract:
* https://github.com/qql-art/contracts/blob/main/contracts/BlacklistOperatorFilter.sol
* @notice This contracts allows tokens or token owners to register specific addresses or codeHashes that may be
* * restricted according to the isOperatorAllowed function.
*/
contract OperatorFilterRegistry is IOperatorFilterRegistry, OperatorFilterRegistryErrorsAndEvents {
using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set;
/// @dev initialized accounts have a nonzero codehash (see https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1052)
/// Note that this will also be a smart contract's codehash when making calls from its constructor.
bytes32 constant EOA_CODEHASH = keccak256("");
mapping(address => EnumerableSet.AddressSet) private _filteredOperators;
mapping(address => EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set) private _filteredCodeHashes;
mapping(address => address) private _registrations;
mapping(address => EnumerableSet.AddressSet) private _subscribers;
/**
* @notice restricts method caller to the address or EIP-173 "owner()"
*/
modifier onlyAddressOrOwner(address addr) {
if (msg.sender != addr) {
try Ownable(addr).owner() returns (address owner) {
if (msg.sender != owner) {
revert OnlyAddressOrOwner();
}
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert NotOwnable();
} else {
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
_;
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if operator is not filtered for a given token, either by address or codeHash. Also returns
* true if supplied registrant address is not registered.
*/
function isOperatorAllowed(address registrant, address operator) external view returns (bool) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != address(0)) {
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage filteredOperatorsRef;
EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set storage filteredCodeHashesRef;
filteredOperatorsRef = _filteredOperators[registration];
filteredCodeHashesRef = _filteredCodeHashes[registration];
if (filteredOperatorsRef.contains(operator)) {
revert AddressFiltered(operator);
}
if (operator.code.length > 0) {
bytes32 codeHash = operator.codehash;
if (filteredCodeHashesRef.contains(codeHash)) {
revert CodeHashFiltered(operator, codeHash);
}
}
}
return true;
}
//////////////////
// AUTH METHODS //
//////////////////
/**
* @notice Registers an address with the registry. May be called by address itself or by EIP-173 owner.
*/
function register(address registrant) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
if (_registrations[registrant] != address(0)) {
revert AlreadyRegistered();
}
_registrations[registrant] = registrant;
emit RegistrationUpdated(registrant, true);
}
/**
* @notice Unregisters an address with the registry and removes its subscription. May be called by address itself or by EIP-173 owner.
* Note that this does not remove any filtered addresses or codeHashes.
* Also note that any subscriptions to this registrant will still be active and follow the existing filtered addresses and codehashes.
*/
function unregister(address registrant) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
_subscribers[registration].remove(registrant);
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, registration, false);
}
_registrations[registrant] = address(0);
emit RegistrationUpdated(registrant, false);
}
/**
* @notice Registers an address with the registry and "subscribes" to another address's filtered operators and codeHashes.
*/
function registerAndSubscribe(address registrant, address subscription) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != address(0)) {
revert AlreadyRegistered();
}
if (registrant == subscription) {
revert CannotSubscribeToSelf();
}
address subscriptionRegistration = _registrations[subscription];
if (subscriptionRegistration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(subscription);
}
if (subscriptionRegistration != subscription) {
revert CannotSubscribeToRegistrantWithSubscription(subscription);
}
_registrations[registrant] = subscription;
_subscribers[subscription].add(registrant);
emit RegistrationUpdated(registrant, true);
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, subscription, true);
}
/**
* @notice Registers an address with the registry and copies the filtered operators and codeHashes from another
* address without subscribing.
*/
function registerAndCopyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
if (registrantToCopy == registrant) {
revert CannotCopyFromSelf();
}
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != address(0)) {
revert AlreadyRegistered();
}
address registrantRegistration = _registrations[registrantToCopy];
if (registrantRegistration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrantToCopy);
}
_registrations[registrant] = registrant;
emit RegistrationUpdated(registrant, true);
_copyEntries(registrant, registrantToCopy);
}
/**
* @notice Update an operator address for a registered address - when filtered is true, the operator is filtered.
*/
function updateOperator(address registrant, address operator, bool filtered)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage filteredOperatorsRef = _filteredOperators[registrant];
if (!filtered) {
bool removed = filteredOperatorsRef.remove(operator);
if (!removed) {
revert AddressNotFiltered(operator);
}
} else {
bool added = filteredOperatorsRef.add(operator);
if (!added) {
revert AddressAlreadyFiltered(operator);
}
}
emit OperatorUpdated(registrant, operator, filtered);
}
/**
* @notice Update a codeHash for a registered address - when filtered is true, the codeHash is filtered.
*/
function updateCodeHash(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash, bool filtered)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
if (codeHash == EOA_CODEHASH) {
revert CannotFilterEOAs();
}
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set storage filteredCodeHashesRef = _filteredCodeHashes[registrant];
if (!filtered) {
bool removed = filteredCodeHashesRef.remove(codeHash);
if (!removed) {
revert CodeHashNotFiltered(codeHash);
}
} else {
bool added = filteredCodeHashesRef.add(codeHash);
if (!added) {
revert CodeHashAlreadyFiltered(codeHash);
}
}
emit CodeHashUpdated(registrant, codeHash, filtered);
}
/**
* @notice Update multiple operators for a registered address - when filtered is true, the operators will be filtered. Reverts on duplicates.
*/
function updateOperators(address registrant, address[] calldata operators, bool filtered)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage filteredOperatorsRef = _filteredOperators[registrant];
uint256 operatorsLength = operators.length;
unchecked {
if (!filtered) {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < operatorsLength; ++i) {
address operator = operators[i];
bool removed = filteredOperatorsRef.remove(operator);
if (!removed) {
revert AddressNotFiltered(operator);
}
}
} else {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < operatorsLength; ++i) {
address operator = operators[i];
bool added = filteredOperatorsRef.add(operator);
if (!added) {
revert AddressAlreadyFiltered(operator);
}
}
}
}
emit OperatorsUpdated(registrant, operators, filtered);
}
/**
* @notice Update multiple codeHashes for a registered address - when filtered is true, the codeHashes will be filtered. Reverts on duplicates.
*/
function updateCodeHashes(address registrant, bytes32[] calldata codeHashes, bool filtered)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set storage filteredCodeHashesRef = _filteredCodeHashes[registrant];
uint256 codeHashesLength = codeHashes.length;
unchecked {
if (!filtered) {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < codeHashesLength; ++i) {
bytes32 codeHash = codeHashes[i];
bool removed = filteredCodeHashesRef.remove(codeHash);
if (!removed) {
revert CodeHashNotFiltered(codeHash);
}
}
} else {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < codeHashesLength; ++i) {
bytes32 codeHash = codeHashes[i];
if (codeHash == EOA_CODEHASH) {
revert CannotFilterEOAs();
}
bool added = filteredCodeHashesRef.add(codeHash);
if (!added) {
revert CodeHashAlreadyFiltered(codeHash);
}
}
}
}
emit CodeHashesUpdated(registrant, codeHashes, filtered);
}
/**
* @notice Subscribe an address to another registrant's filtered operators and codeHashes. Will remove previous
* subscription if present.
* Note that accounts with subscriptions may go on to subscribe to other accounts - in this case,
* subscriptions will not be forwarded. Instead the former subscription's existing entries will still be
* used.
*/
function subscribe(address registrant, address newSubscription) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
if (registrant == newSubscription) {
revert CannotSubscribeToSelf();
}
if (newSubscription == address(0)) {
revert CannotSubscribeToZeroAddress();
}
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration == newSubscription) {
revert AlreadySubscribed(newSubscription);
}
address newSubscriptionRegistration = _registrations[newSubscription];
if (newSubscriptionRegistration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(newSubscription);
}
if (newSubscriptionRegistration != newSubscription) {
revert CannotSubscribeToRegistrantWithSubscription(newSubscription);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
_subscribers[registration].remove(registrant);
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, registration, false);
}
_registrations[registrant] = newSubscription;
_subscribers[newSubscription].add(registrant);
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, newSubscription, true);
}
/**
* @notice Unsubscribe an address from its current subscribed registrant, and optionally copy its filtered operators and codeHashes.
*/
function unsubscribe(address registrant, bool copyExistingEntries) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration == registrant) {
revert NotSubscribed();
}
_subscribers[registration].remove(registrant);
_registrations[registrant] = registrant;
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, registration, false);
if (copyExistingEntries) {
_copyEntries(registrant, registration);
}
}
/**
* @notice Copy filtered operators and codeHashes from a different registrantToCopy to addr.
*/
function copyEntriesOf(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
if (registrant == registrantToCopy) {
revert CannotCopyFromSelf();
}
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
address registrantRegistration = _registrations[registrantToCopy];
if (registrantRegistration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrantToCopy);
}
_copyEntries(registrant, registrantToCopy);
}
/// @dev helper to copy entries from registrantToCopy to registrant and emit events
function _copyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) private {
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage filteredOperatorsRef = _filteredOperators[registrantToCopy];
EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set storage filteredCodeHashesRef = _filteredCodeHashes[registrantToCopy];
uint256 filteredOperatorsLength = filteredOperatorsRef.length();
uint256 filteredCodeHashesLength = filteredCodeHashesRef.length();
unchecked {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < filteredOperatorsLength; ++i) {
address operator = filteredOperatorsRef.at(i);
bool added = _filteredOperators[registrant].add(operator);
if (added) {
emit OperatorUpdated(registrant, operator, true);
}
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < filteredCodeHashesLength; ++i) {
bytes32 codehash = filteredCodeHashesRef.at(i);
bool added = _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].add(codehash);
if (added) {
emit CodeHashUpdated(registrant, codehash, true);
}
}
}
}
//////////////////
// VIEW METHODS //
//////////////////
/**
* @notice Get the subscription address of a given registrant, if any.
*/
function subscriptionOf(address registrant) external view returns (address subscription) {
subscription = _registrations[registrant];
if (subscription == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
} else if (subscription == registrant) {
subscription = address(0);
}
}
/**
* @notice Get the set of addresses subscribed to a given registrant.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function subscribers(address registrant) external view returns (address[] memory) {
return _subscribers[registrant].values();
}
/**
* @notice Get the subscriber at a given index in the set of addresses subscribed to a given registrant.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function subscriberAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external view returns (address) {
return _subscribers[registrant].at(index);
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if operator is filtered by a given address or its subscription.
*/
function isOperatorFiltered(address registrant, address operator) external view returns (bool) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredOperators[registration].contains(operator);
}
return _filteredOperators[registrant].contains(operator);
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if a codeHash is filtered by a given address or its subscription.
*/
function isCodeHashFiltered(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash) external view returns (bool) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredCodeHashes[registration].contains(codeHash);
}
return _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].contains(codeHash);
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if the hash of an address's code is filtered by a given address or its subscription.
*/
function isCodeHashOfFiltered(address registrant, address operatorWithCode) external view returns (bool) {
bytes32 codeHash = operatorWithCode.codehash;
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredCodeHashes[registration].contains(codeHash);
}
return _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].contains(codeHash);
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if an address has registered
*/
function isRegistered(address registrant) external view returns (bool) {
return _registrations[registrant] != address(0);
}
/**
* @notice Returns a list of filtered operators for a given address or its subscription.
*/
function filteredOperators(address registrant) external view returns (address[] memory) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredOperators[registration].values();
}
return _filteredOperators[registrant].values();
}
/**
* @notice Returns the set of filtered codeHashes for a given address or its subscription.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function filteredCodeHashes(address registrant) external view returns (bytes32[] memory) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredCodeHashes[registration].values();
}
return _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].values();
}
/**
* @notice Returns the filtered operator at the given index of the set of filtered operators for a given address or
* its subscription.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function filteredOperatorAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external view returns (address) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredOperators[registration].at(index);
}
return _filteredOperators[registrant].at(index);
}
/**
* @notice Returns the filtered codeHash at the given index of the list of filtered codeHashes for a given address or
* its subscription.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function filteredCodeHashAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external view returns (bytes32) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredCodeHashes[registration].at(index);
}
return _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].at(index);
}
/// @dev Convenience method to compute the code hash of an arbitrary contract
function codeHashOf(address a) external view returns (bytes32) {
return a.codehash;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
contract OperatorFilterRegistryErrorsAndEvents {
error CannotFilterEOAs();
error AddressAlreadyFiltered(address operator);
error AddressNotFiltered(address operator);
error CodeHashAlreadyFiltered(bytes32 codeHash);
error CodeHashNotFiltered(bytes32 codeHash);
error OnlyAddressOrOwner();
error NotRegistered(address registrant);
error AlreadyRegistered();
error AlreadySubscribed(address subscription);
error NotSubscribed();
error CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(address subscription);
error CannotSubscribeToSelf();
error CannotSubscribeToZeroAddress();
error NotOwnable();
error AddressFiltered(address filtered);
error CodeHashFiltered(address account, bytes32 codeHash);
error CannotSubscribeToRegistrantWithSubscription(address registrant);
error CannotCopyFromSelf();
event RegistrationUpdated(address indexed registrant, bool indexed registered);
event OperatorUpdated(address indexed registrant, address indexed operator, bool indexed filtered);
event OperatorsUpdated(address indexed registrant, address[] operators, bool indexed filtered);
event CodeHashUpdated(address indexed registrant, bytes32 indexed codeHash, bool indexed filtered);
event CodeHashesUpdated(address indexed registrant, bytes32[] codeHashes, bool indexed filtered);
event SubscriptionUpdated(address indexed registrant, address indexed subscription, bool indexed subscribed);
}
File 10 of 10: WyvernProxyRegistry
pragma solidity ^0.4.13;
contract Ownable {
address public owner;
event OwnershipRenounced(address indexed previousOwner);
event OwnershipTransferred(
address indexed previousOwner,
address indexed newOwner
);
/**
* @dev The Ownable constructor sets the original `owner` of the contract to the sender
* account.
*/
constructor() public {
owner = msg.sender;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(msg.sender == owner);
_;
}
/**
* @dev Allows the current owner to transfer control of the contract to a newOwner.
* @param newOwner The address to transfer ownership to.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0));
emit OwnershipTransferred(owner, newOwner);
owner = newOwner;
}
/**
* @dev Allows the current owner to relinquish control of the contract.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public onlyOwner {
emit OwnershipRenounced(owner);
owner = address(0);
}
}
contract ERC20Basic {
function totalSupply() public view returns (uint256);
function balanceOf(address who) public view returns (uint256);
function transfer(address to, uint256 value) public returns (bool);
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
}
contract ERC20 is ERC20Basic {
function allowance(address owner, address spender)
public view returns (uint256);
function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 value)
public returns (bool);
function approve(address spender, uint256 value) public returns (bool);
event Approval(
address indexed owner,
address indexed spender,
uint256 value
);
}
contract TokenRecipient {
event ReceivedEther(address indexed sender, uint amount);
event ReceivedTokens(address indexed from, uint256 value, address indexed token, bytes extraData);
/**
* @dev Receive tokens and generate a log event
* @param from Address from which to transfer tokens
* @param value Amount of tokens to transfer
* @param token Address of token
* @param extraData Additional data to log
*/
function receiveApproval(address from, uint256 value, address token, bytes extraData) public {
ERC20 t = ERC20(token);
require(t.transferFrom(from, this, value));
emit ReceivedTokens(from, value, token, extraData);
}
/**
* @dev Receive Ether and generate a log event
*/
function () payable public {
emit ReceivedEther(msg.sender, msg.value);
}
}
contract ProxyRegistry is Ownable {
/* DelegateProxy implementation contract. Must be initialized. */
address public delegateProxyImplementation;
/* Authenticated proxies by user. */
mapping(address => OwnableDelegateProxy) public proxies;
/* Contracts pending access. */
mapping(address => uint) public pending;
/* Contracts allowed to call those proxies. */
mapping(address => bool) public contracts;
/* Delay period for adding an authenticated contract.
This mitigates a particular class of potential attack on the Wyvern DAO (which owns this registry) - if at any point the value of assets held by proxy contracts exceeded the value of half the WYV supply (votes in the DAO),
a malicious but rational attacker could buy half the Wyvern and grant themselves access to all the proxy contracts. A delay period renders this attack nonthreatening - given two weeks, if that happened, users would have
plenty of time to notice and transfer their assets.
*/
uint public DELAY_PERIOD = 2 weeks;
/**
* Start the process to enable access for specified contract. Subject to delay period.
*
* @dev ProxyRegistry owner only
* @param addr Address to which to grant permissions
*/
function startGrantAuthentication (address addr)
public
onlyOwner
{
require(!contracts[addr] && pending[addr] == 0);
pending[addr] = now;
}
/**
* End the process to nable access for specified contract after delay period has passed.
*
* @dev ProxyRegistry owner only
* @param addr Address to which to grant permissions
*/
function endGrantAuthentication (address addr)
public
onlyOwner
{
require(!contracts[addr] && pending[addr] != 0 && ((pending[addr] + DELAY_PERIOD) < now));
pending[addr] = 0;
contracts[addr] = true;
}
/**
* Revoke access for specified contract. Can be done instantly.
*
* @dev ProxyRegistry owner only
* @param addr Address of which to revoke permissions
*/
function revokeAuthentication (address addr)
public
onlyOwner
{
contracts[addr] = false;
}
/**
* Register a proxy contract with this registry
*
* @dev Must be called by the user which the proxy is for, creates a new AuthenticatedProxy
* @return New AuthenticatedProxy contract
*/
function registerProxy()
public
returns (OwnableDelegateProxy proxy)
{
require(proxies[msg.sender] == address(0));
proxy = new OwnableDelegateProxy(msg.sender, delegateProxyImplementation, abi.encodeWithSignature("initialize(address,address)", msg.sender, address(this)));
proxies[msg.sender] = proxy;
return proxy;
}
}
contract WyvernProxyRegistry is ProxyRegistry {
string public constant name = "Project Wyvern Proxy Registry";
/* Whether the initial auth address has been set. */
bool public initialAddressSet = false;
constructor ()
public
{
delegateProxyImplementation = new AuthenticatedProxy();
}
/**
* Grant authentication to the initial Exchange protocol contract
*
* @dev No delay, can only be called once - after that the standard registry process with a delay must be used
* @param authAddress Address of the contract to grant authentication
*/
function grantInitialAuthentication (address authAddress)
onlyOwner
public
{
require(!initialAddressSet);
initialAddressSet = true;
contracts[authAddress] = true;
}
}
contract OwnedUpgradeabilityStorage {
// Current implementation
address internal _implementation;
// Owner of the contract
address private _upgradeabilityOwner;
/**
* @dev Tells the address of the owner
* @return the address of the owner
*/
function upgradeabilityOwner() public view returns (address) {
return _upgradeabilityOwner;
}
/**
* @dev Sets the address of the owner
*/
function setUpgradeabilityOwner(address newUpgradeabilityOwner) internal {
_upgradeabilityOwner = newUpgradeabilityOwner;
}
/**
* @dev Tells the address of the current implementation
* @return address of the current implementation
*/
function implementation() public view returns (address) {
return _implementation;
}
/**
* @dev Tells the proxy type (EIP 897)
* @return Proxy type, 2 for forwarding proxy
*/
function proxyType() public pure returns (uint256 proxyTypeId) {
return 2;
}
}
contract AuthenticatedProxy is TokenRecipient, OwnedUpgradeabilityStorage {
/* Whether initialized. */
bool initialized = false;
/* Address which owns this proxy. */
address public user;
/* Associated registry with contract authentication information. */
ProxyRegistry public registry;
/* Whether access has been revoked. */
bool public revoked;
/* Delegate call could be used to atomically transfer multiple assets owned by the proxy contract with one order. */
enum HowToCall { Call, DelegateCall }
/* Event fired when the proxy access is revoked or unrevoked. */
event Revoked(bool revoked);
/**
* Initialize an AuthenticatedProxy
*
* @param addrUser Address of user on whose behalf this proxy will act
* @param addrRegistry Address of ProxyRegistry contract which will manage this proxy
*/
function initialize (address addrUser, ProxyRegistry addrRegistry)
public
{
require(!initialized);
initialized = true;
user = addrUser;
registry = addrRegistry;
}
/**
* Set the revoked flag (allows a user to revoke ProxyRegistry access)
*
* @dev Can be called by the user only
* @param revoke Whether or not to revoke access
*/
function setRevoke(bool revoke)
public
{
require(msg.sender == user);
revoked = revoke;
emit Revoked(revoke);
}
/**
* Execute a message call from the proxy contract
*
* @dev Can be called by the user, or by a contract authorized by the registry as long as the user has not revoked access
* @param dest Address to which the call will be sent
* @param howToCall Which kind of call to make
* @param calldata Calldata to send
* @return Result of the call (success or failure)
*/
function proxy(address dest, HowToCall howToCall, bytes calldata)
public
returns (bool result)
{
require(msg.sender == user || (!revoked && registry.contracts(msg.sender)));
if (howToCall == HowToCall.Call) {
result = dest.call(calldata);
} else if (howToCall == HowToCall.DelegateCall) {
result = dest.delegatecall(calldata);
}
return result;
}
/**
* Execute a message call and assert success
*
* @dev Same functionality as `proxy`, just asserts the return value
* @param dest Address to which the call will be sent
* @param howToCall What kind of call to make
* @param calldata Calldata to send
*/
function proxyAssert(address dest, HowToCall howToCall, bytes calldata)
public
{
require(proxy(dest, howToCall, calldata));
}
}
contract Proxy {
/**
* @dev Tells the address of the implementation where every call will be delegated.
* @return address of the implementation to which it will be delegated
*/
function implementation() public view returns (address);
/**
* @dev Tells the type of proxy (EIP 897)
* @return Type of proxy, 2 for upgradeable proxy
*/
function proxyType() public pure returns (uint256 proxyTypeId);
/**
* @dev Fallback function allowing to perform a delegatecall to the given implementation.
* This function will return whatever the implementation call returns
*/
function () payable public {
address _impl = implementation();
require(_impl != address(0));
assembly {
let ptr := mload(0x40)
calldatacopy(ptr, 0, calldatasize)
let result := delegatecall(gas, _impl, ptr, calldatasize, 0, 0)
let size := returndatasize
returndatacopy(ptr, 0, size)
switch result
case 0 { revert(ptr, size) }
default { return(ptr, size) }
}
}
}
contract OwnedUpgradeabilityProxy is Proxy, OwnedUpgradeabilityStorage {
/**
* @dev Event to show ownership has been transferred
* @param previousOwner representing the address of the previous owner
* @param newOwner representing the address of the new owner
*/
event ProxyOwnershipTransferred(address previousOwner, address newOwner);
/**
* @dev This event will be emitted every time the implementation gets upgraded
* @param implementation representing the address of the upgraded implementation
*/
event Upgraded(address indexed implementation);
/**
* @dev Upgrades the implementation address
* @param implementation representing the address of the new implementation to be set
*/
function _upgradeTo(address implementation) internal {
require(_implementation != implementation);
_implementation = implementation;
emit Upgraded(implementation);
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyProxyOwner() {
require(msg.sender == proxyOwner());
_;
}
/**
* @dev Tells the address of the proxy owner
* @return the address of the proxy owner
*/
function proxyOwner() public view returns (address) {
return upgradeabilityOwner();
}
/**
* @dev Allows the current owner to transfer control of the contract to a newOwner.
* @param newOwner The address to transfer ownership to.
*/
function transferProxyOwnership(address newOwner) public onlyProxyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0));
emit ProxyOwnershipTransferred(proxyOwner(), newOwner);
setUpgradeabilityOwner(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Allows the upgradeability owner to upgrade the current implementation of the proxy.
* @param implementation representing the address of the new implementation to be set.
*/
function upgradeTo(address implementation) public onlyProxyOwner {
_upgradeTo(implementation);
}
/**
* @dev Allows the upgradeability owner to upgrade the current implementation of the proxy
* and delegatecall the new implementation for initialization.
* @param implementation representing the address of the new implementation to be set.
* @param data represents the msg.data to bet sent in the low level call. This parameter may include the function
* signature of the implementation to be called with the needed payload
*/
function upgradeToAndCall(address implementation, bytes data) payable public onlyProxyOwner {
upgradeTo(implementation);
require(address(this).delegatecall(data));
}
}
contract OwnableDelegateProxy is OwnedUpgradeabilityProxy {
constructor(address owner, address initialImplementation, bytes calldata)
public
{
setUpgradeabilityOwner(owner);
_upgradeTo(initialImplementation);
require(initialImplementation.delegatecall(calldata));
}
}